1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
4 @settitle Semi-gnus 6.8.6 Manual
9 @c * Gnus: (gnus). The news reader gnus.
14 @setchapternewpage odd
18 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
19 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
20 \usepackage{pagestyle}
28 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
29 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
31 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
33 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
34 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
36 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
37 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
39 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\fontfamily{pfu}\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont #1}}
40 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
41 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\fontfamily{pfu}\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont #1}''}
42 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
43 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
44 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
45 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
46 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
47 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
48 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
49 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
50 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
51 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
52 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
54 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
55 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
56 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
57 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
58 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
59 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
60 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
61 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
62 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
63 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
64 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
66 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head.eps,height=1cm}}}
67 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
68 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
71 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
73 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
80 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
82 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
84 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
85 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
88 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
89 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
90 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
95 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
97 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
104 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
105 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/#1-up.ps,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/#1-up.ps,height=1cm}}}
108 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
109 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
112 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
113 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
116 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
117 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
120 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
122 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
123 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
127 \newenvironment{codelist}%
132 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
138 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
143 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
148 \newenvironment{samplist}%
153 \newenvironment{varlist}%
158 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
163 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
164 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
165 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
167 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
172 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
176 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
185 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
187 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
192 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
197 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
201 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
209 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
211 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
221 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
225 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
233 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
235 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
240 \pagenumbering{roman}
241 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
251 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
252 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
254 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
256 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\\
259 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=15cm}
262 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
269 \thispagestyle{empty}
271 Copyright \copyright{} 1995,96,97 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
273 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
274 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
275 are preserved on all copies.
277 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
278 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the
279 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
280 permission notice identical to this one.
282 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
283 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
292 This file documents gnus, the GNU Emacs newsreader.
294 Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
296 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
297 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
298 are preserved on all copies.
301 Permission is granted to process this file through Tex and print the
302 results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
303 notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
304 (this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
307 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
308 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
309 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
310 permission notice identical to this one.
312 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
313 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
319 @title Semi-gnus 6.8.6 Manual
321 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
324 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
325 Copyright @copyright{} 1995,96,97 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
327 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
328 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
329 are preserved on all copies.
331 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
332 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the
333 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
334 permission notice identical to this one.
336 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
337 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
346 @top The gnus Newsreader
350 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using gnus. The news
351 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@sc{nntp}, local
352 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
355 Semi-gnus provides MIME features based on SEMI API. So Semi-gnus
356 supports your right to read strange messages including big images or
357 other various kinds of formats. Semi-gnus also supports
358 internationalization/localization and multiscript features based on MULE
359 API. So Semi-gnus does not discriminate various language communities.
360 Oh, if you are a Klingon, please wait Unicode Next Generation.
362 This manual corresponds to Semi-gnus 6.8.6.
373 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
374 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
377 being accused of plagiarism:
379 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
380 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
381 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you can
382 even read news with it!
384 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
385 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
386 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend gnus to make it behave
387 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
388 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
395 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
396 * The Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
397 * The Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
398 * The Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
399 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
400 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
401 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
402 * Various:: General purpose settings.
403 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
404 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, FAQ, History, Internals.
405 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
406 * Key Index:: Key Index.
410 @chapter Starting gnus
415 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting gnus
416 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
419 @findex gnus-other-frame
420 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
421 If you want to start gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
422 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
424 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
425 variables in your @file{~/.gnus} file. This file is similar to
426 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when gnus starts.
428 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
429 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
432 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
433 * The First Time:: What does gnus do the first time you start it?
434 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
435 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one gnus active at a time.
436 * Fetching a Group:: Starting gnus just to read a group.
437 * New Groups:: What is gnus supposed to do with new groups?
438 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
439 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
440 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
441 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
442 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
446 @node Finding the News
447 @section Finding the News
450 @vindex gnus-select-method
452 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where gnus should look for
453 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
454 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
455 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are foreign
458 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @sc{nntp} server is where
459 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
462 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
465 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
468 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
471 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
472 certainly be much faster.
474 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
476 @cindex @sc{nntp} server
477 If this variable is not set, gnus will take a look at the
478 @code{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
479 gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
480 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter. If
481 that fails as well, gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs as an
482 @sc{nntp} server. That's a long shot, though.
484 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
485 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
486 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
487 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
489 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
490 You can also make gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
491 @sc{nntp} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
492 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), gnus will let you choose between the servers
493 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
494 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting.
496 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
498 However, if you use one @sc{nntp} server regularly and are just
499 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
500 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
501 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
502 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
503 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
505 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
507 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
508 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
509 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
510 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
511 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
512 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
515 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} backend to read your mail, you
516 would typically set this variable to
519 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
524 @section The First Time
525 @cindex first time usage
527 If no startup files exist, gnus will try to determine what groups should
528 be subscribed by default.
530 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
531 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, gnus
532 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
533 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
536 Since she hasn't, gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
537 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
538 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
540 You'll also be subscribed to the gnus documentation group, which should
541 help you with most common problems.
543 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, gnus will just
544 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
548 @node The Server is Down
549 @section The Server is Down
550 @cindex server errors
552 If the default server is down, gnus will understandably have some
553 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
554 the news groups, you may want to start gnus anyway.
556 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
557 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
558 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
559 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
560 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
561 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
562 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
564 @findex gnus-no-server
565 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
567 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
568 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
569 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start gnus. That might come in handy
570 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
571 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
572 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
577 @section Slave Gnusae
580 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one gnus at the
581 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if
582 you are using the two different gnusae to read from two different
583 servers), that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
585 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
588 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the gnus
589 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and @dfn{slaves}.
590 (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have taken out a
591 copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in conjunction
592 with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to me. Usage of
593 the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer Applications})
594 will be much more expensive, of course.)
596 Anyways, you start one gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
597 however you do it). Each subsequent slave gnusae should be started with
598 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
599 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
600 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master gnus
601 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
602 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
603 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
605 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
606 information in the normal (i.e., master) @code{.newsrc} file.
609 @node Fetching a Group
610 @section Fetching a Group
611 @cindex fetching a group
613 @findex gnus-fetch-group
614 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
615 group and I don't care whether gnus has been started or not''. This is
616 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
617 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
618 It takes the group name as a parameter.
626 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
627 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
628 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
629 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
630 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
631 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
632 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
633 @code{always}, then gnus will query the backends for new groups even
634 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
637 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
638 * Subscription Methods:: What gnus should do with new groups.
639 * Filtering New Groups:: Making gnus ignore certain new groups.
643 @node Checking New Groups
644 @subsection Checking New Groups
646 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
647 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
648 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
649 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, gnus will ask the
650 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
651 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
652 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
653 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
654 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
655 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
657 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
658 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
659 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
660 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
661 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't work.
662 I could write a function to make gnus guess whether the server supports
663 @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't. You could
664 @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see whether it lists
665 @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If it does, then it
666 might work. (But there are servers that lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} without
667 supporting the function properly.)
669 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, gnus will
670 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
671 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
672 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
673 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
674 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
677 @node Subscription Methods
678 @subsection Subscription Methods
680 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
681 What gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
682 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
684 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
685 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
687 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
691 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
692 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
693 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
694 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
695 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
697 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
698 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
699 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
700 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
702 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
703 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
704 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
706 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
707 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
708 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
709 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
710 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
711 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into it's
712 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
713 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
714 up. Or something like that.
716 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
717 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
718 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that gnus will ask you
719 about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe to
720 will be subscribed hierarchically.
722 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
723 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
728 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
729 A closely related variable is
730 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
731 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, gnus will ask you in a
732 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
733 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
736 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
737 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
738 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
739 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
742 @node Filtering New Groups
743 @subsection Filtering New Groups
745 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
746 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
747 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
750 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
753 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
754 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
755 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
756 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
757 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
758 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
759 subscribing these groups.
760 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
761 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
763 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
764 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
765 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
766 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
767 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
768 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
769 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
770 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
772 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
773 Yet another variable that meddles here is
774 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
775 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous, but I
776 thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is more
777 meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is used
778 more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new groups
779 that come from mail backends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
780 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, and @code{nnmh}) subscribed. If you
781 don't like that, just set this variable to @code{nil}.
783 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
784 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
787 @node Changing Servers
788 @section Changing Servers
789 @cindex changing servers
791 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @sc{nntp} server to another.
792 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
793 very flaky and you want to use another.
795 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
796 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
800 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
801 @sc{nntp} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
802 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
803 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
806 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
807 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
808 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
809 functions more than absolutely necessary.
811 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
812 @findex gnus-change-server
813 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
814 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
815 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
816 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
817 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
819 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
820 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
821 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
822 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
823 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
825 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
826 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
827 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
828 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
829 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
830 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
834 @section Startup Files
835 @cindex startup files
840 Now, you all know about the @file{.newsrc} file. All subscription
841 information is traditionally stored in this file.
843 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{GNUS}. In addition to
844 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
845 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
846 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
847 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{GNUS} would read whichever one of these
848 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
849 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
851 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
852 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
853 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
854 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
855 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
856 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
858 In addition, gnus does not change anything. Hail comrade Lars!
860 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
861 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
862 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
863 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from gnus faster.
864 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
865 gnus. But hey, who would want to, right?
867 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
868 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
869 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
870 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
871 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
872 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
873 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
874 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
875 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
876 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
877 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
878 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
880 @vindex gnus-startup-file
881 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
882 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
883 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
885 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
886 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
887 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
888 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
889 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
890 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
891 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
892 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
893 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
894 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
897 (defun turn-off-backup ()
898 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
900 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
901 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
904 @vindex gnus-init-file
905 When gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
906 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
907 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
908 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
909 @file{site-init} files with gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
910 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
911 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
912 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
913 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order).
922 Whenever you do something that changes the gnus data (reading articles,
923 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
924 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
925 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
926 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
929 If gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
930 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file
933 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
934 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, gnus won't create and
935 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
937 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
938 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
939 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, gnus will dribble
940 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
941 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
942 file permissions as the @code{.newsrc} file.
944 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
945 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
946 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
949 @node The Active File
950 @section The Active File
952 @cindex ignored groups
954 When gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
955 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
956 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
958 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
959 Before examining the active file, gnus deletes all lines that match the
960 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
961 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make gnus
962 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
963 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
964 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
967 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
968 @c if you set it to anything else.
970 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
972 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
973 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent gnus from
974 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
976 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
977 you actually subscribe to.
979 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
980 variable to @code{nil} will probably make gnus slower, not faster. At
981 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow gnus down
982 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
984 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
985 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
986 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
987 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
988 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
989 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
991 If this variable is @code{nil}, gnus will ask for group info in total
992 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
993 @sc{nntp} server, gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
994 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
995 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
996 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
998 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
999 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1001 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1002 secondary select methods.
1005 @node Startup Variables
1006 @section Startup Variables
1010 @item gnus-load-hook
1011 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1012 A hook run while gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1013 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1014 times you start gnus.
1016 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1017 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1018 A hook run after starting up gnus successfully.
1020 @item gnus-startup-hook
1021 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1022 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up gnus
1024 @item gnus-started-hook
1025 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1026 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up gnus
1029 @item gnus-started-hook
1030 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1031 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1032 generating the group buffer.
1034 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1035 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1036 If non-@code{nil}, gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1037 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1038 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1039 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1040 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1041 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1043 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1044 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1045 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1046 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1047 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1048 @file{.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @code{.emacs} instead.
1050 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1051 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1052 Message displayed by gnus when no groups are available.
1054 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1055 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1056 If non-@code{nil}, play the gnus jingle at startup.
1058 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1059 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1060 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1061 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1066 @node The Group Buffer
1067 @chapter The Group Buffer
1068 @cindex group buffer
1070 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1071 is the first buffer shown when gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1072 long as gnus is active.
1076 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1077 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=tmp/group.ps,height=9cm}}
1078 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1079 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1080 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1081 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1082 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1083 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1089 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1090 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1091 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1092 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1093 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1094 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1095 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1096 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1097 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1098 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1099 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1100 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1101 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1102 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1103 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1104 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1105 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1109 @node Group Buffer Format
1110 @section Group Buffer Format
1113 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1114 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
1115 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1119 @node Group Line Specification
1120 @subsection Group Line Specification
1121 @cindex group buffer format
1123 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1124 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1126 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1129 25: news.announce.newusers
1130 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1135 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1136 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1137 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1138 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1140 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1141 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1142 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1143 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1144 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1145 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1147 @samp{%M%S%5y: %(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1149 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1150 the colon after performing an operation. Nothing else is required---not
1151 even the group name. All displayed text is just window dressing, and is
1152 never examined by gnus. Gnus stores all real information it needs using
1155 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1156 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1157 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1159 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1164 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1167 Whether the group is subscribed.
1170 Level of subscribedness.
1173 Number of unread articles.
1176 Number of dormant articles.
1179 Number of ticked articles.
1182 Number of read articles.
1185 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1186 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1189 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1192 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1201 Newsgroup description.
1204 @samp{m} if moderated.
1207 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1216 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1220 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1223 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1224 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1225 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1226 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1227 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.emacs.gnus}.
1230 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1232 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1236 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1240 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1241 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1242 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1243 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1244 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1245 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1250 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1251 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1252 group, or a bogus native group.
1255 @node Group Modeline Specification
1256 @subsection Group Modeline Specification
1257 @cindex group modeline
1259 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1260 The mode line can be changed by setting
1261 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1262 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1266 The native news server.
1268 The native select method.
1272 @node Group Highlighting
1273 @subsection Group Highlighting
1274 @cindex highlighting
1275 @cindex group highlighting
1277 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1278 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1279 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1280 that look like @var{(form . face)}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1281 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1283 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1287 (face-spec-set 'my-group-face-1 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))))
1288 (face-spec-set 'my-group-face-2 '((t (:foreground "SeaGreen" :bold t))))
1289 (face-spec-set 'my-group-face-3 '((t (:foreground "SpringGreen" :bold t))))
1290 (face-spec-set 'my-group-face-4 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))))
1291 (face-spec-set 'my-group-face-5 '((t (:foreground "SkyBlue" :bold t))))
1293 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1294 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1295 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1296 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1297 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1298 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1301 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1303 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1310 The number of unread articles in the group.
1314 Whether the group is a mail group.
1316 The level of the group.
1318 The score of the group.
1320 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1322 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather, MAX-NUMBER minus
1323 MIN-NUMBER plus one.
1325 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1326 topic being inserted.
1329 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1330 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal gnus
1331 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1333 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1334 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1335 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1336 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1337 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1340 @node Group Maneuvering
1341 @section Group Maneuvering
1342 @cindex group movement
1344 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1345 expected, hopefully.
1351 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1352 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1353 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1359 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1360 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1361 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1365 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1366 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1370 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1371 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
1375 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
1376 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
1377 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
1381 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
1382 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
1383 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
1386 Three commands for jumping to groups:
1392 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
1393 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
1394 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
1399 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
1400 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
1401 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
1405 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
1406 Jump to the first group with unread articles
1407 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
1410 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
1411 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
1412 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
1413 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
1417 @node Selecting a Group
1418 @section Selecting a Group
1419 @cindex group selection
1424 @kindex SPACE (Group)
1425 @findex gnus-group-read-group
1426 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
1427 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
1428 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
1429 this command, gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
1430 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{N}, @var{N}
1431 determines the number of articles gnus will fetch. If @var{N} is
1432 positive, gnus fetches the @var{N} newest articles, if @var{N} is
1433 negative, gnus fetches the @var{abs(N)} oldest articles.
1437 @findex gnus-group-select-group
1438 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
1439 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
1440 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
1441 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
1445 @kindex M-RET (Group)
1446 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
1447 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
1448 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
1449 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
1450 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
1451 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
1452 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
1453 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
1454 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
1457 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
1458 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
1459 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
1460 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
1461 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
1464 @kindex M-C-RET (Group)
1465 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
1466 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
1467 doing any processing of its contents
1468 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
1469 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
1470 manner will have no permanent effects.
1474 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
1475 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what gnus should consider
1476 to be a big group. This is 200 by default. If the group has more
1477 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, gnus will query the user
1478 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many articles
1479 should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a negative
1480 number (@code{-n}), the @code{n} oldest articles will be fetched. If it
1481 is positive, the @code{n} articles that have arrived most recently will
1484 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
1485 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
1486 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} control whether any articles are selected
1487 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
1492 Don't select any articles when entering the group. Just display the
1493 full summary buffer.
1496 Select the first unread article when entering the group.
1499 Select the highest scored article in the group when entering the
1503 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
1504 binary group with Huge articles) you can set this variable to @code{nil}
1505 in @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
1509 @node Subscription Commands
1510 @section Subscription Commands
1511 @cindex subscription
1519 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
1520 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
1521 Toggle subscription to the current group
1522 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
1528 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
1529 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
1530 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
1531 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
1537 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
1538 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
1539 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
1545 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
1546 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
1549 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
1550 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
1551 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
1552 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
1553 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
1559 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
1560 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
1564 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
1565 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
1568 @kindex S C-k (Group)
1569 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
1570 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
1571 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
1572 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
1573 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
1574 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
1575 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
1576 @file{.newsrc} file.
1580 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1590 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
1591 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
1592 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
1593 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
1594 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
1595 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group
1596 from the group buffer.
1600 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
1601 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
1602 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
1606 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1607 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
1608 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1610 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1611 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1612 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1613 If you have switched from one @sc{nntp} server to another, all your marks
1614 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
1615 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
1622 @section Group Levels
1626 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
1627 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
1628 can ask gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
1629 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
1630 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1632 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
1638 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
1639 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
1640 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
1641 prompted for a level.
1644 @vindex gnus-level-killed
1645 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
1646 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
1647 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
1648 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
1649 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
1650 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
1651 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
1652 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
1653 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
1654 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
1655 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
1656 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
1657 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
1658 reasons of efficiency.
1660 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
1661 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
1663 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
1664 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
1665 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
1667 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
1668 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
1669 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
1670 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
1671 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
1672 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
1673 relevant valid ranges.
1675 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
1676 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
1677 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
1678 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
1679 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
1680 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
1683 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
1684 All groups with a level less than or equal to
1685 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
1688 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
1689 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
1690 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
1691 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
1694 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
1695 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
1696 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
1697 use this level as the ``work'' level.
1699 @vindex gnus-activate-level
1700 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
1701 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
1702 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
1703 to 5. The default is 6.
1707 @section Group Score
1712 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
1713 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
1714 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
1717 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can assign a score to each
1718 group. You can then sort the group buffer based on this score.
1719 Alternatively, you can sort on score and then level. (Taken together,
1720 the level and the score is called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group
1721 that is on level 4 and has a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group
1722 on level 5 that has a score of 300. (The level is the most significant
1723 part and the score is the least significant part.))
1725 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
1726 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
1727 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
1728 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
1729 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
1730 action after each summary exit, you can add
1731 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
1732 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
1733 slow things down somewhat.
1736 @node Marking Groups
1737 @section Marking Groups
1738 @cindex marking groups
1740 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
1741 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
1742 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
1743 bidding on those groups.
1745 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
1746 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
1747 with the process mark and then execute the command.
1755 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
1756 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
1762 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
1763 Remove the mark from the current group
1764 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
1768 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
1769 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
1773 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
1774 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
1778 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
1779 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
1783 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
1784 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
1785 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
1788 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
1790 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
1791 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
1792 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
1793 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
1794 the command to be executed.
1797 @node Foreign Groups
1798 @section Foreign Groups
1799 @cindex foreign groups
1801 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
1802 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
1803 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
1804 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
1811 @findex gnus-group-make-group
1812 @cindex making groups
1813 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
1814 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
1815 to subscribe to @sc{nntp} groups, @pxref{Browse Foreign Server}.
1819 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
1820 @cindex renaming groups
1821 Rename the current group to something else
1822 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
1823 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
1829 @findex gnus-group-customize
1830 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
1834 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
1835 @cindex renaming groups
1836 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
1837 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
1841 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
1842 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
1843 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
1847 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
1848 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
1849 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
1853 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
1855 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
1856 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
1861 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
1862 Make the gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
1866 @cindex (ding) archive
1867 @cindex archive group
1868 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
1869 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
1870 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
1871 Make a gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
1872 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
1873 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
1874 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
1878 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
1880 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
1881 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
1882 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
1883 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
1887 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
1889 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
1890 @code{nneething} backend (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
1891 @xref{Anything Groups}.
1895 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
1896 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
1898 Make a group based on some file or other
1899 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
1900 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
1901 Currently supported types are @code{babyl}, @code{mbox}, @code{digest},
1902 @code{mmdf}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{clari-briefs},
1903 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, and @code{forward}. If you run
1904 this command without a prefix, gnus will guess at the file type.
1905 @xref{Document Groups}.
1909 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
1914 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
1915 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
1916 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
1917 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
1918 include @code{dejanews}, @code{altavista} and @code{reference}.
1919 @xref{Web Searches}.
1921 If you use the @code{dejanews} search engine, you can limit the search
1922 to a particular group by using a match string like
1923 @samp{~g alt.sysadmin.recovery shaving}.
1926 @kindex G DEL (Group)
1927 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
1928 This function will delete the current group
1929 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
1930 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
1931 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
1932 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
1933 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} group), though.
1937 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
1938 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
1939 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
1943 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
1944 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
1945 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
1948 @xref{Select Methods} for more information on the various select
1951 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
1952 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
1953 gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
1954 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
1955 groups from different @sc{nntp} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
1956 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
1960 @node Group Parameters
1961 @section Group Parameters
1962 @cindex group parameters
1964 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
1965 Here's an example group parameter list:
1968 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
1972 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing
1973 before the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value.
1974 All the parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs,
1975 which are not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
1977 The following group parameters can be used:
1982 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
1985 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
1988 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
1989 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
1990 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
1991 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
1992 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
1994 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
1995 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
1996 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
1997 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
1998 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
1999 list address instead.
2003 Address used when doing a @kbd{a} in that group.
2006 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2009 It is totally ignored
2010 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2011 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2013 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2014 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2015 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2016 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2017 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2019 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you don't have a
2020 @code{to-list} group parameter, one will be added automatically upon
2021 sending the message.
2025 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2026 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2027 of whether it has any unread articles.
2029 @item broken-reply-to
2030 @cindex broken-reply-to
2031 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2032 headers in this group are to be ignored. This can be useful if you're
2033 reading a mailing list group where the listserv has inserted
2034 @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv itself. This is
2035 broken behavior. So there!
2039 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2040 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2044 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, gnus
2045 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2046 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2051 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2052 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2053 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2054 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2055 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2056 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2057 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2061 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2062 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2063 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2066 @cindex total-expire
2067 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2068 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2069 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2070 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2075 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2076 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(expiry-wait
2077 . 10)}, this value will override any @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and
2078 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} when expiring expirable messages.
2079 The value can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or
2080 the symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2083 @cindex score file group parameter
2084 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2085 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2086 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2089 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2090 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2091 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2092 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2095 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2096 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2097 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2098 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2101 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2102 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2106 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2109 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2114 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2115 arbitrary comments on the group. They are currently ignored by gnus,
2116 but provide a place for you to store information on particular groups.
2118 @item @var{(variable form)}
2119 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2120 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2121 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2122 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2123 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2124 @code{eval}ed there.
2126 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function, if you'd like.
2127 If you want to hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put
2128 something like @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that
2129 group. @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the result of the
2130 @code{(ding)} form, but who cares?
2134 Use the @kbd{G p} command to edit group parameters of a group. You
2135 might also be interested in reading about topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
2139 @node Listing Groups
2140 @section Listing Groups
2141 @cindex group listing
2143 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
2151 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
2152 List all groups that have unread articles
2153 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
2154 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
2155 only lists groups of level five (i. e.,
2156 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
2163 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
2164 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
2165 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
2166 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
2167 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
2168 unsubscribed groups).
2172 @findex gnus-group-list-level
2173 List all unread groups on a specific level
2174 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
2175 with no unread articles.
2179 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
2180 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
2181 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
2182 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
2187 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
2188 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
2192 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
2193 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
2194 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
2198 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
2199 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
2203 @findex gnus-group-list-active
2204 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
2205 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
2206 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
2207 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
2208 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
2209 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
2210 Take the output with some grains of salt.
2214 @findex gnus-group-apropos
2215 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
2216 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
2220 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
2221 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
2222 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
2226 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
2227 @cindex visible group parameter
2228 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
2229 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
2230 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
2231 get the same effect.
2233 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
2234 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
2235 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
2236 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
2237 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
2240 @node Sorting Groups
2241 @section Sorting Groups
2242 @cindex sorting groups
2244 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
2245 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
2246 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
2247 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
2248 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
2249 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
2254 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
2255 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
2256 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
2258 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
2259 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
2260 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
2262 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
2263 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
2264 Sort by group level.
2266 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
2267 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
2268 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
2270 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
2271 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
2272 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
2273 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
2275 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
2276 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
2277 Sort by number of unread articles.
2279 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
2280 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
2281 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
2286 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
2287 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
2291 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
2292 some sorting criteria:
2296 @kindex G S a (Group)
2297 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
2298 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
2299 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
2302 @kindex G S u (Group)
2303 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
2304 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
2305 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
2308 @kindex G S l (Group)
2309 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
2310 Sort the group buffer by group level
2311 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
2314 @kindex G S v (Group)
2315 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
2316 Sort the group buffer by group score
2317 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2320 @kindex G S r (Group)
2321 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
2322 Sort the group buffer by group rank
2323 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2326 @kindex G S m (Group)
2327 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
2328 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by backend name
2329 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
2333 When given a prefix, all these commands will sort in reverse order.
2335 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
2339 @kindex G P a (Group)
2340 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
2341 Sort the process/prefixed groups in the group buffer alphabetically by
2342 group name (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
2345 @kindex G P u (Group)
2346 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
2347 Sort the process/prefixed groups in the group buffer by the number of
2348 unread articles (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
2351 @kindex G P l (Group)
2352 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
2353 Sort the process/prefixed groups in the group buffer by group level
2354 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
2357 @kindex G P v (Group)
2358 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
2359 Sort the process/prefixed groups in the group buffer by group score
2360 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2363 @kindex G P r (Group)
2364 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
2365 Sort the process/prefixed groups in the group buffer by group rank
2366 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2369 @kindex G P m (Group)
2370 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
2371 Sort the process/prefixed groups in the group buffer alphabetically by
2372 backend name (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
2378 @node Group Maintenance
2379 @section Group Maintenance
2380 @cindex bogus groups
2385 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
2386 Find bogus groups and delete them
2387 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
2391 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
2392 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
2393 If given a prefix, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
2397 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
2398 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
2399 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
2400 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}).
2403 @kindex C-c M-C-x (Group)
2404 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
2405 Run all articles in all groups through the expiry process
2406 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
2411 @node Browse Foreign Server
2412 @section Browse Foreign Server
2413 @cindex foreign servers
2414 @cindex browsing servers
2419 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
2420 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
2421 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
2422 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
2425 @findex gnus-browse-mode
2426 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
2427 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
2428 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
2430 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
2435 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2436 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2440 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2441 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2444 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
2445 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
2446 Enter the current group and display the first article
2447 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
2450 @kindex RET (Browse)
2451 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
2452 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
2456 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
2457 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
2458 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2464 @findex gnus-browse-exit
2465 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
2469 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
2470 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
2471 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
2476 @section Exiting gnus
2477 @cindex exiting gnus
2479 Yes, gnus is ex(c)iting.
2484 @findex gnus-group-suspend
2485 Suspend gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit
2486 gnus, but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure
2487 why this is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
2491 @findex gnus-group-exit
2492 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
2493 Quit gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
2497 @findex gnus-group-quit
2498 Quit gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files
2499 (@code{gnus-group-quit}). The dribble file will be saved, though
2500 (@pxref{Auto Save}).
2503 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
2504 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
2505 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend gnus and
2506 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit gnus, while
2507 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
2512 If you wish to completely unload gnus and all its adherents, you can use
2513 the @code{gnus-unload} command. This command is also very handy when
2514 trying to customize meta-variables.
2519 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
2520 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
2521 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
2527 @section Group Topics
2530 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
2531 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
2532 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
2533 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
2534 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
2535 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
2539 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
2540 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=tmp/group-topic.ps,height=9cm}}
2551 2: alt.religion.emacs
2554 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
2556 8: comp.binaries.fractals
2557 13: comp.sources.unix
2560 @findex gnus-topic-mode
2562 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
2563 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
2564 is a toggling command.)
2566 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
2567 dum... Nice tune, that... la la la... What, you're back? Yes, and now
2568 press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed under
2569 @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy? Hot and
2572 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
2573 the hook for the group mode:
2576 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
2580 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
2581 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
2582 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
2583 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
2584 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
2588 @node Topic Variables
2589 @subsection Topic Variables
2590 @cindex topic variables
2592 Now, if you select a topic, it will fold/unfold that topic, which is
2593 really neat, I think.
2595 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
2596 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
2597 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
2610 Number of groups in the topic.
2612 Number of unread articles in the topic.
2614 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
2617 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
2618 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
2619 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
2622 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
2623 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
2625 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
2626 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
2627 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
2630 @node Topic Commands
2631 @subsection Topic Commands
2632 @cindex topic commands
2634 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
2635 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
2636 definitions slightly.
2642 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
2643 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
2644 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
2648 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
2649 Move the current group to some other topic
2650 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
2651 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
2655 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
2656 Copy the current group to some other topic
2657 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
2658 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
2662 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
2663 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
2664 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
2665 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
2666 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
2667 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
2668 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
2671 This command uses the process/prefix convention
2672 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
2676 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
2677 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
2678 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
2682 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
2683 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
2684 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
2688 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
2689 Toggle hiding empty topics
2690 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
2694 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
2695 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
2696 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}).
2699 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
2700 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
2701 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
2702 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}).
2706 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
2708 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
2709 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
2710 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
2711 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
2712 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
2713 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
2717 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
2719 @findex gnus-topic-indent
2720 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
2721 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
2722 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
2725 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
2726 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
2727 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
2728 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
2732 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
2733 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
2734 topic will be removed along with the topic.
2738 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
2739 Yank the previously killed group or topic
2740 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
2745 @findex gnus-topic-rename
2746 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
2749 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
2750 @findex gnus-topic-delete
2751 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
2755 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
2756 List all groups that gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
2757 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
2761 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
2762 @cindex group parameters
2763 @cindex topic parameters
2765 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
2766 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
2772 @subsection Topic Sorting
2773 @cindex topic sorting
2775 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
2781 @kindex T S a (Topic)
2782 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
2783 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
2784 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
2787 @kindex T S u (Topic)
2788 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
2789 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
2790 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
2793 @kindex T S l (Topic)
2794 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
2795 Sort the current topic by group level
2796 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
2799 @kindex T S v (Topic)
2800 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
2801 Sort the current topic by group score
2802 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2805 @kindex T S r (Topic)
2806 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
2807 Sort the current topic by group rank
2808 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2811 @kindex T S m (Topic)
2812 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
2813 Sort the current topic alphabetically by backend name
2814 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
2818 @xref{Sorting Groups} for more information about group sorting.
2821 @node Topic Topology
2822 @subsection Topic Topology
2823 @cindex topic topology
2826 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
2832 2: alt.religion.emacs
2835 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
2837 8: comp.binaries.fractals
2838 13: comp.sources.unix
2841 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
2842 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
2843 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
2848 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
2849 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
2853 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
2854 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
2855 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
2856 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
2857 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
2858 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
2860 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
2861 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
2862 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
2865 @node Topic Parameters
2866 @subsection Topic Parameters
2867 @cindex topic parameters
2869 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent (and
2870 ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid topic
2871 parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
2873 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
2874 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
2875 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
2876 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
2882 2: alt.religion.emacs
2886 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
2888 8: comp.binaries.fractals
2889 13: comp.sources.unix
2893 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
2894 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
2895 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
2896 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
2897 @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
2898 . "religion.SCORE")}.
2900 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
2901 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
2902 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
2903 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
2904 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
2906 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
2907 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
2908 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
2909 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
2910 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
2911 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
2912 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
2913 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
2916 @node Misc Group Stuff
2917 @section Misc Group Stuff
2920 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
2921 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and gnus.
2922 * Group Timestamp:: Making gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
2923 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the gnus files.
2930 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
2931 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
2932 @xref{The Server Buffer}.
2936 @findex gnus-group-post-news
2937 Post an article to a group (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a
2938 prefix, the current group name will be used as the default.
2942 @findex gnus-group-mail
2943 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}).
2947 Variables for the group buffer:
2951 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
2952 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
2953 is called after the group buffer has been
2956 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
2957 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
2958 is called after the group buffer is
2959 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
2962 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
2963 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
2964 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
2965 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
2967 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
2968 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
2969 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
2970 whether they are empty or not.
2975 @node Scanning New Messages
2976 @subsection Scanning New Messages
2977 @cindex new messages
2978 @cindex scanning new news
2984 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
2985 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
2986 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
2987 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
2988 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
2989 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
2994 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
2995 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
2996 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
2997 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
2998 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
2999 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
3000 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
3002 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
3003 @cindex activating groups
3005 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
3006 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
3011 @findex gnus-group-restart
3012 Restart gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
3013 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
3014 gnus variables, and then starts gnus all over again.
3018 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
3019 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
3021 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
3022 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
3026 @node Group Information
3027 @subsection Group Information
3028 @cindex group information
3029 @cindex information on groups
3036 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
3037 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
3040 Try to fetch the FAQ for the current group
3041 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the FAQ from
3042 @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on a
3043 remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories. In
3044 that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
3045 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be used
3046 for fetching the file.
3048 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, gnus will attempt to go
3049 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
3053 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
3055 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
3056 @cindex describing groups
3057 @cindex group description
3058 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
3059 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
3060 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
3064 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
3065 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
3066 prefix, force gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
3073 @findex gnus-version
3074 Display current gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
3078 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
3079 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
3082 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
3085 @findex gnus-info-find-node
3086 Go to the gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
3090 @node Group Timestamp
3091 @subsection Group Timestamp
3093 @cindex group timestamps
3095 It can be convenient to let gnus keep track of when you last read a
3096 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
3097 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
3100 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
3103 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
3105 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
3106 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
3109 (setq gnus-group-line-format
3110 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
3113 This will result in lines looking like:
3116 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
3117 0: custom 19961002T012713
3120 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
3121 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
3125 (setq gnus-group-line-format
3126 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
3131 @subsection File Commands
3132 @cindex file commands
3138 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
3139 @vindex gnus-init-file
3140 @cindex reading init file
3141 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
3142 @file{~/.gnus}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
3146 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
3147 @cindex saving .newsrc
3148 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
3149 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
3150 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
3153 @c @kindex Z (Group)
3154 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
3155 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
3160 @node The Summary Buffer
3161 @chapter The Summary Buffer
3162 @cindex summary buffer
3164 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
3165 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
3167 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
3168 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
3170 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
3173 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
3174 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
3175 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
3176 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
3177 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
3178 * Canceling and Superseding:: ``Whoops, I shouldn't have called him that.''
3179 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
3180 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
3181 * Threading:: How threads are made.
3182 * Sorting:: How articles and threads are sorted.
3183 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
3184 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
3185 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
3186 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
3187 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
3188 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
3189 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
3190 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
3191 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
3192 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
3193 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
3194 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
3195 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
3196 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
3197 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer.
3198 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
3199 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
3203 @node Summary Buffer Format
3204 @section Summary Buffer Format
3205 @cindex summary buffer format
3209 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
3210 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary.ps,width=7.5cm}}
3211 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-article.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
3217 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
3218 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
3219 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
3222 @findex mail-extract-address-components
3223 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
3224 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
3225 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
3226 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
3227 @code{From} header. Three pre-defined functions exist:
3228 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
3229 fast, and too simplistic solution;
3230 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works nicely, but is
3231 slower; and @code{std11-extract-address-components}, which works very
3232 nicely, but is slower. The default function will return the wrong
3233 answer in 5% of the cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use one of
3234 the other functions instead.
3236 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
3237 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
3238 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
3239 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
3242 @node Summary Buffer Lines
3243 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
3245 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
3246 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
3247 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
3248 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
3249 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3251 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20n%]%) %s\n}.
3253 The following format specification characters are understood:
3261 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
3262 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
3263 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
3265 Full @code{From} header.
3267 The name (from the @code{From} header).
3269 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
3270 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
3271 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
3272 may be more thorough.
3274 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
3277 Number of lines in the article.
3279 Number of characters in the article.
3281 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
3283 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
3284 pushes everything after it off the screen).
3286 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
3287 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
3289 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
3290 for adopted articles.
3292 One space for each thread level.
3294 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
3299 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
3300 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
3304 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
3306 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
3307 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
3308 default level. If the difference between
3309 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
3310 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
3318 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
3320 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
3326 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
3327 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
3329 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
3330 article has any children.
3336 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
3337 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
3338 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
3339 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
3340 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
3341 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
3344 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
3345 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, gnus will
3346 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
3347 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
3348 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
3349 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
3351 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
3352 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
3354 This restriction may disappear in later versions of gnus.
3357 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
3358 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
3360 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
3361 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
3362 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
3363 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
3365 Here are the elements you can play with:
3371 Unprefixed group name.
3373 Current article number.
3375 Current article score.
3379 Number of unread articles in this group.
3381 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
3384 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
3385 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
3386 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
3387 and no unselected ones.
3389 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
3390 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
3392 Subject of the current article.
3394 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
3396 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
3398 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
3400 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
3402 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
3404 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
3408 @node Summary Highlighting
3409 @subsection Summary Highlighting
3413 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
3414 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
3415 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
3416 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
3417 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
3419 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
3420 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
3421 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
3422 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
3424 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
3425 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
3426 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
3427 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
3429 @item gnus-summary-highlight
3430 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
3431 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
3432 list where the elements are of the format @var{(FORM . FACE)}. If you
3433 would, for instance, like ticked articles to be italic and high-scored
3434 articles to be bold, you could set this variable to something like
3436 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
3437 ((> score default) . bold))
3439 As you may have guessed, if @var{FORM} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
3440 @var{FACE} will be applied to the line.
3444 @node Summary Maneuvering
3445 @section Summary Maneuvering
3446 @cindex summary movement
3448 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
3449 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
3451 None of these commands select articles.
3456 @kindex M-n (Summary)
3457 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
3458 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
3459 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
3460 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
3464 @kindex M-p (Summary)
3465 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
3466 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
3467 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
3468 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
3473 @kindex G j (Summary)
3474 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
3475 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
3476 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
3479 @kindex G g (Summary)
3480 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
3481 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
3482 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
3485 If gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
3486 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
3487 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
3488 to the group buffer.
3490 Variables related to summary movement:
3494 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
3495 @item gnus-auto-select-next
3496 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
3497 no more unread articles after the current one, gnus will offer to go to
3498 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
3499 empty, gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
3500 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, gnus will select the
3501 next group, no matter whether it has any unread articles or not. As a
3502 special case, if this variable is @code{quietly}, gnus will select the
3503 next group without asking for confirmation. If this variable is
3504 @code{almost-quietly}, the same will happen only if you are located on
3505 the last article in the group. Finally, if this variable is
3506 @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n} command will go to the next group
3507 without confirmation. Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
3509 @item gnus-auto-select-same
3510 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
3511 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
3512 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
3513 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
3514 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
3515 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
3517 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
3519 @item gnus-summary-check-current
3520 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
3521 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
3522 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
3523 Instead, they will choose the current article.
3525 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
3526 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
3527 If non-@code{nil}, gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
3528 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
3529 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
3530 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
3531 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
3532 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
3538 @node Choosing Articles
3539 @section Choosing Articles
3540 @cindex selecting articles
3543 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
3544 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
3548 @node Choosing Commands
3549 @subsection Choosing Commands
3551 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
3552 and they all select and display an article.
3556 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
3557 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
3558 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
3559 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
3564 @kindex G n (Summary)
3565 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
3566 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
3567 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
3572 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
3573 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
3574 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
3579 @kindex G N (Summary)
3580 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
3581 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
3586 @kindex G P (Summary)
3587 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
3588 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
3591 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
3592 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
3593 Go to the next article with the same subject
3594 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
3597 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
3598 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
3599 Go to the previous article with the same subject
3600 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
3604 @kindex G f (Summary)
3606 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
3607 Go to the first unread article
3608 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
3612 @kindex G b (Summary)
3614 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
3615 Go to the article with the highest score
3616 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}).
3621 @kindex G l (Summary)
3622 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
3623 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
3626 @kindex G o (Summary)
3627 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
3629 @cindex article history
3630 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
3631 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
3632 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
3633 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
3634 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
3635 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
3639 @node Choosing Variables
3640 @subsection Choosing Variables
3642 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
3645 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
3646 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
3647 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
3648 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
3649 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
3650 the server and display it in the article buffer.
3652 @item gnus-select-article-hook
3653 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
3654 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
3655 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article.
3657 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
3658 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
3659 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
3660 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
3661 @findex gnus-unread-mark
3662 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
3663 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
3664 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
3665 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
3666 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
3667 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
3668 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
3669 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
3670 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
3675 @node Paging the Article
3676 @section Scrolling the Article
3677 @cindex article scrolling
3682 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
3683 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
3684 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
3685 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
3686 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
3689 @kindex DEL (Summary)
3690 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
3691 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
3694 @kindex RET (Summary)
3695 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
3696 Scroll the current article one line forward
3697 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
3701 @kindex A g (Summary)
3703 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
3704 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
3705 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
3706 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
3707 the way it came from the server.
3712 @kindex A < (Summary)
3713 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
3714 Scroll to the beginning of the article
3715 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
3720 @kindex A > (Summary)
3721 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
3722 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
3726 @kindex A s (Summary)
3728 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
3729 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
3730 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
3734 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
3735 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
3740 @node Reply Followup and Post
3741 @section Reply, Followup and Post
3744 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
3745 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
3749 @node Summary Mail Commands
3750 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
3752 @cindex composing mail
3754 Commands for composing a mail message:
3760 @kindex S r (Summary)
3762 @findex gnus-summary-reply
3763 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
3764 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
3765 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
3766 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
3771 @kindex S R (Summary)
3772 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
3773 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
3774 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
3775 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
3776 command uses the process/prefix convention.
3779 @kindex S w (Summary)
3780 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
3781 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
3782 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
3783 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
3784 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers.
3787 @kindex S W (Summary)
3788 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
3789 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
3790 message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This command uses
3791 the process/prefix convention.
3794 @kindex S o m (Summary)
3795 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
3796 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
3797 Forward the current article to some other person
3798 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If given a prefix, include the full
3799 headers of the forwarded article.
3804 @kindex S m (Summary)
3805 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
3806 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
3807 Send a mail to some other person
3808 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}).
3811 @kindex S D b (Summary)
3812 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
3813 @cindex bouncing mail
3814 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
3815 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
3816 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
3817 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
3818 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
3819 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, gnus will try to fetch
3820 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
3821 very well fail, though.
3824 @kindex S D r (Summary)
3825 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
3826 Not to be confused with the previous command,
3827 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
3828 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
3829 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
3830 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
3831 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
3832 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
3833 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
3835 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
3836 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
3837 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
3838 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
3839 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung mu
\e(I_
\e(B sein!
3841 This command understands the process/prefix convention
3842 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3845 @kindex S O m (Summary)
3846 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
3847 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
3848 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
3849 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3852 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
3853 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
3854 @cindex crossposting
3855 @cindex excessive crossposting
3856 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
3857 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
3859 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
3860 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
3861 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
3862 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
3863 command understands the process/prefix convention
3864 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
3868 Also @pxref{(message)Header Commands} for more information.
3871 @node Summary Post Commands
3872 @subsection Summary Post Commands
3874 @cindex composing news
3876 Commands for posting a news article:
3882 @kindex S p (Summary)
3883 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
3884 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
3885 Post an article to the current group
3886 (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}).
3891 @kindex S f (Summary)
3892 @findex gnus-summary-followup
3893 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
3894 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
3898 @kindex S F (Summary)
3900 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
3901 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
3902 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
3903 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
3904 process/prefix convention.
3907 @kindex S n (Summary)
3908 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
3909 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
3910 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
3913 @kindex S N (Summary)
3914 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
3915 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
3916 message through mail and include the original message
3917 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
3918 the process/prefix convention.
3921 @kindex S o p (Summary)
3922 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
3923 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
3924 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}). If given a prefix, include the full
3925 headers of the forwarded article.
3928 @kindex S O p (Summary)
3929 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
3931 @cindex making digests
3932 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
3933 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
3934 process/prefix convention.
3937 @kindex S u (Summary)
3938 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
3939 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
3940 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
3941 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
3944 Also @pxref{(message)Header Commands} for more information.
3947 @node Canceling and Superseding
3948 @section Canceling Articles
3949 @cindex canceling articles
3950 @cindex superseding articles
3952 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
3953 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
3955 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
3957 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
3959 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
3960 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
3961 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
3962 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
3963 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
3964 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3966 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
3967 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
3970 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
3971 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
3972 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
3974 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
3975 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
3976 your original article.
3978 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
3980 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
3981 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
3982 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
3985 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
3986 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
3987 have posted almost the same article twice.
3989 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
3990 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
3991 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
3992 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
3993 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
3994 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
3995 header by substituting one of those words for the word
3996 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
3997 you would do normally. The previous article will be
3998 canceled/superseded.
4000 Just remember, kids: There is no `c' in `supersede'.
4003 @node Marking Articles
4004 @section Marking Articles
4005 @cindex article marking
4006 @cindex article ticking
4009 There are several marks you can set on an article.
4011 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
4012 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
4013 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
4015 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
4018 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
4019 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
4020 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
4024 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks:
4028 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
4029 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
4033 @node Unread Articles
4034 @subsection Unread Articles
4036 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
4041 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
4042 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
4044 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
4045 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
4046 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
4047 tick it. However, articles can be expired, so if you want to keep an
4048 article forever, you'll have to make it persistent (@pxref{Persistent
4052 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
4053 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
4055 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
4056 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
4057 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
4060 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
4061 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
4063 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
4068 @subsection Read Articles
4069 @cindex expirable mark
4071 All the following marks mark articles as read.
4076 @vindex gnus-del-mark
4077 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
4078 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
4081 @vindex gnus-read-mark
4082 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
4085 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
4086 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
4087 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
4090 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
4091 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
4094 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
4095 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
4098 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
4099 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
4102 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
4103 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
4106 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
4107 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
4110 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
4111 @sc{SOUP}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
4114 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
4115 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
4119 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
4120 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
4121 (@code{gnus-duplicated-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
4125 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
4126 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
4128 One more special mark, though:
4132 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
4133 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
4135 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
4136 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
4137 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
4138 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by gnus at any time.
4143 @subsection Other Marks
4144 @cindex process mark
4147 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
4153 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
4154 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
4155 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
4156 in the article, and gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
4157 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}
4160 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
4161 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
4162 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
4163 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
4166 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
4167 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
4168 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}
4171 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
4172 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
4173 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
4174 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
4177 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
4178 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
4179 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
4180 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
4181 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
4184 @vindex gnus-process-mark
4185 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
4186 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
4187 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
4188 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
4189 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
4193 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
4194 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
4195 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
4197 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
4198 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
4199 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
4203 @subsection Setting Marks
4204 @cindex setting marks
4206 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
4211 @kindex M c (Summary)
4212 @kindex M-u (Summary)
4213 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
4214 @cindex mark as unread
4215 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
4216 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
4222 @kindex M t (Summary)
4223 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
4224 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
4225 @xref{Article Caching}
4230 @kindex M ? (Summary)
4231 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
4232 Mark the current article as dormant
4233 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}
4237 @kindex M d (Summary)
4239 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
4240 Mark the current article as read
4241 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
4245 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
4246 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
4247 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
4252 @kindex M k (Summary)
4253 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
4254 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
4255 and then select the next unread article
4256 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
4260 @kindex M K (Summary)
4261 @kindex C-k (Summary)
4262 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
4263 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
4264 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
4267 @kindex M C (Summary)
4268 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
4269 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
4270 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
4273 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
4274 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
4275 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
4276 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
4279 @kindex M H (Summary)
4280 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
4281 Catchup the current group to point
4282 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
4285 @kindex C-w (Summary)
4286 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
4287 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
4288 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
4291 @kindex M V k (Summary)
4292 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
4293 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
4294 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
4298 @kindex M e (Summary)
4300 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
4301 Mark the current article as expirable
4302 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
4305 @kindex M b (Summary)
4306 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
4307 Set a bookmark in the current article
4308 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
4311 @kindex M B (Summary)
4312 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
4313 Remove the bookmark from the current article
4314 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
4317 @kindex M V c (Summary)
4318 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
4319 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
4320 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
4323 @kindex M V u (Summary)
4324 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
4325 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
4326 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
4329 @kindex M V m (Summary)
4330 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
4331 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
4332 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
4333 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
4336 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
4337 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
4338 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
4339 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
4340 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
4341 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
4342 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
4343 The default is @code{t}.
4346 @node Setting Process Marks
4347 @subsection Setting Process Marks
4348 @cindex setting process marks
4355 @kindex M P p (Summary)
4356 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
4357 Mark the current article with the process mark
4358 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
4359 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
4363 @kindex M P u (Summary)
4364 @kindex M-# (Summary)
4365 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
4366 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
4369 @kindex M P U (Summary)
4370 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
4371 Remove the process mark from all articles
4372 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
4375 @kindex M P i (Summary)
4376 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
4377 Invert the list of process marked articles
4378 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
4381 @kindex M P R (Summary)
4382 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
4383 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
4384 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
4387 @kindex M P r (Summary)
4388 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
4389 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
4392 @kindex M P t (Summary)
4393 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
4394 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
4395 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
4398 @kindex M P T (Summary)
4399 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
4400 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
4401 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
4404 @kindex M P v (Summary)
4405 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
4406 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
4407 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
4410 @kindex M P s (Summary)
4411 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
4412 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
4415 @kindex M P S (Summary)
4416 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
4417 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
4418 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
4421 @kindex M P a (Summary)
4422 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
4423 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
4426 @kindex M P b (Summary)
4427 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
4428 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
4429 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
4432 @kindex M P k (Summary)
4433 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
4434 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
4435 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
4438 @kindex M P y (Summary)
4439 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
4440 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
4441 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
4444 @kindex M P w (Summary)
4445 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
4446 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
4447 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
4456 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
4457 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
4458 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
4461 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
4462 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
4463 additional articles.
4469 @kindex / / (Summary)
4470 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
4471 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
4472 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}).
4475 @kindex / a (Summary)
4476 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
4477 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
4478 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}).
4482 @kindex / u (Summary)
4484 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
4485 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
4486 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
4487 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
4488 dormant articles will also be excluded.
4491 @kindex / m (Summary)
4492 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
4493 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
4494 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
4497 @kindex / t (Summary)
4498 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
4499 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
4500 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}). If given a prefix, limit to
4501 articles younger than that number of days.
4504 @kindex / n (Summary)
4505 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
4506 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
4507 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
4508 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4511 @kindex / w (Summary)
4512 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
4513 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
4514 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
4518 @kindex / v (Summary)
4519 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
4520 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
4521 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
4525 @kindex M S (Summary)
4526 @kindex / E (Summary)
4527 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
4528 Include all expunged articles in the limit
4529 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
4532 @kindex / D (Summary)
4533 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
4534 Include all dormant articles in the limit
4535 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
4538 @kindex / * (Summary)
4539 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
4540 Include all cached articles in the limit
4541 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
4544 @kindex / d (Summary)
4545 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
4546 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
4547 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
4550 @kindex / T (Summary)
4551 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
4552 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
4555 @kindex / c (Summary)
4556 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
4557 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit
4558 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
4561 @kindex / C (Summary)
4562 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
4563 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
4564 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
4565 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
4573 @cindex article threading
4575 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
4576 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
4577 hierarchical fashion.
4579 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
4580 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
4581 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
4582 or simply missing. Weird news propagation excarcerbates the problem,
4583 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
4584 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
4585 @pxref{Customizing Threading}.
4587 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
4591 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
4594 A tree-like article structure.
4597 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
4600 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
4601 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
4602 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
4603 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
4604 called loose threads.
4606 @item thread gathering
4607 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
4609 @item sparse threads
4610 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
4611 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
4617 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
4618 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
4622 @node Customizing Threading
4623 @subsection Customizing Threading
4624 @cindex customizing threading
4627 * Loose Threads:: How gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
4628 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
4629 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
4630 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
4635 @subsubsection Loose Threads
4638 @cindex loose threads
4641 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
4642 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
4643 If non-@code{nil}, gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
4644 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
4645 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
4646 read or killed the root in a previous session.
4648 When there is no real root of a thread, gnus will have to fudge
4649 something. This variable says what fudging method gnus should use.
4650 There are four possible values:
4654 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
4655 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-adopt.ps,width=7.5cm}}
4656 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-empty.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
4657 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-none.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
4658 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-dummy.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
4663 @cindex adopting articles
4668 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
4669 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
4670 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
4671 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
4674 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
4675 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
4676 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
4677 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
4678 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
4679 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
4680 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
4683 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
4684 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
4685 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
4689 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
4690 display them after one another.
4693 Don't gather loose threads.
4696 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
4697 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
4698 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
4699 variable is @code{nil}, gnus requires an exact match between the
4700 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
4701 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
4702 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
4703 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
4704 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
4705 variable to a really low number, you'll find that gnus will gather
4706 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
4708 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
4709 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, gnus will
4710 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
4713 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
4714 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
4715 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
4716 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
4717 simplification is used.
4719 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
4720 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
4721 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
4722 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
4724 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
4726 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
4732 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
4733 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
4734 "answer" "reference" "announce"
4735 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
4740 (mapconcat 'identity
4741 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
4743 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
4746 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
4749 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
4750 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
4751 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
4752 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
4753 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
4754 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
4756 Useful functions to put in this list include:
4759 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
4760 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
4761 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
4763 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
4764 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
4767 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
4768 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
4769 Remove excessive whitespace.
4772 You may also write your own functions, of course.
4775 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
4776 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
4777 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
4778 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
4779 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
4780 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
4781 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
4782 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
4784 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
4785 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
4786 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
4787 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
4788 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
4789 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
4790 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
4791 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
4792 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
4796 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
4797 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
4798 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
4799 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
4801 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
4802 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
4803 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
4806 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
4810 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
4811 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
4817 @node Filling In Threads
4818 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
4821 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
4822 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
4823 If non-@code{nil}, gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
4824 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
4825 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
4826 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
4827 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
4828 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
4829 old headers only works if the backend you are using carries overview
4830 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and
4831 @code{nnml}. Also remember that if the root of the thread has been
4832 expired by the server, there's not much gnus can do about that.
4834 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
4835 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
4836 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
4838 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
4839 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
4840 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
4841 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
4842 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
4843 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
4844 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where gnus guesses that an article
4845 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
4846 lines. If you select a gap, gnus will try to fetch the article in
4847 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, gnus will display all these
4848 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
4849 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, gnus won't cut
4850 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
4851 @code{nil} by default.
4856 @node More Threading
4857 @subsubsection More Threading
4860 @item gnus-show-threads
4861 @vindex gnus-show-threads
4862 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
4863 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
4864 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
4865 slower and more awkward.
4867 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
4868 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
4869 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
4872 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
4873 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
4874 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
4875 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
4876 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
4877 threads are expunged.
4879 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
4880 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
4881 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
4884 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
4885 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
4886 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
4887 this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subject change is ignored. If it
4888 is @code{nil}, which is the default, a change in the subject will result
4891 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
4892 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
4893 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
4899 @node Low-Level Threading
4900 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
4904 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
4905 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
4906 Hook run before parsing any headers. The default value is
4907 @code{(gnus-set-summary-default-charset)}, which sets up local value of
4908 @code{default-mime-charset} in summary buffer based on variable
4909 @code{gnus-newsgroup-default-charset-alist}.
4911 @item gnus-alter-header-function
4912 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
4913 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
4914 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
4915 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
4916 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
4917 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
4918 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
4919 meaningful. Here's one example:
4922 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
4924 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
4925 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
4927 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
4929 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
4936 @node Thread Commands
4937 @subsection Thread Commands
4938 @cindex thread commands
4944 @kindex T k (Summary)
4945 @kindex M-C-k (Summary)
4946 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
4947 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
4948 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
4949 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
4954 @kindex T l (Summary)
4955 @kindex M-C-l (Summary)
4956 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
4957 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
4958 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
4961 @kindex T i (Summary)
4962 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
4963 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
4964 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
4967 @kindex T # (Summary)
4968 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
4969 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
4970 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
4973 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
4974 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
4975 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
4976 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
4979 @kindex T T (Summary)
4980 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
4981 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
4984 @kindex T s (Summary)
4985 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
4986 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any
4987 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
4990 @kindex T h (Summary)
4991 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
4992 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
4995 @kindex T S (Summary)
4996 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
4997 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
5000 @kindex T H (Summary)
5001 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
5002 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
5005 @kindex T t (Summary)
5006 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
5007 Re-thread the current article's thread
5008 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
5009 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
5012 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
5013 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
5014 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
5015 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
5019 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
5020 understand the numeric prefix.
5025 @kindex T n (Summary)
5026 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
5027 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
5030 @kindex T p (Summary)
5031 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
5032 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
5035 @kindex T d (Summary)
5036 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
5037 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
5040 @kindex T u (Summary)
5041 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
5042 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
5045 @kindex T o (Summary)
5046 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
5047 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
5050 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
5051 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
5052 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
5053 a command like `T k' (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
5054 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
5055 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
5056 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
5057 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
5058 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
5059 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
5060 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
5061 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
5068 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
5069 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
5070 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
5071 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
5072 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
5073 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
5074 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
5075 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
5076 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which is a list of functions.
5077 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
5078 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
5079 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
5080 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score}, and
5081 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
5083 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
5084 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
5085 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. If you use
5086 more than one function, the primary sort key should be the last function
5087 in the list. You should probably always include
5088 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
5089 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
5090 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
5091 ascending article order.
5093 If you would like to sort by score, then by subject, and finally by
5094 number, you could do something like:
5097 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
5098 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
5099 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
5100 gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score))
5103 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
5104 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
5105 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
5106 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
5107 which the articles arrived.
5109 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
5113 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
5115 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
5116 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
5119 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
5120 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
5121 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
5122 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
5125 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
5126 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
5127 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
5128 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
5129 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
5130 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
5131 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or other,
5132 you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions} variable.
5133 It is very similar to the @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that
5134 it uses slightly different functions for article comparison. Available
5135 sorting predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
5136 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject},
5137 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date}, and @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
5139 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
5143 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
5144 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
5145 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
5150 @node Asynchronous Fetching
5151 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
5152 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
5153 @cindex article pre-fetch
5156 If you read your news from an @sc{nntp} server that's far away, the
5157 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
5158 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
5159 article appears. Why can't gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
5160 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
5162 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
5163 article fetching, especially the way gnus does it.
5165 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
5166 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
5167 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
5168 article 3, but since gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
5169 connection is blocked.
5171 To avoid these situations, gnus will open two (count 'em two)
5172 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
5173 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
5174 extra connection takes some time, so gnus startup will be slower.
5176 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
5177 the link between your machine and the @sc{nntp} server will become more
5178 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
5179 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
5182 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing... unless
5185 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
5186 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
5187 happen automatically.
5189 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
5190 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
5191 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
5192 that when you read an article in the group, the backend will pre-fetch
5193 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the backend will
5194 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
5195 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
5197 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
5198 @findex gnus-async-read-p
5199 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
5200 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p} variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This function should
5201 return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is to be
5202 pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which returns
5203 @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an article
5204 data structure as the only parameter.
5206 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
5207 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
5210 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
5211 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
5212 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
5213 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
5216 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
5219 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
5220 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down gnus too much. It's
5221 probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
5223 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
5224 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
5225 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
5226 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
5230 Remove articles when they are read.
5233 Remove articles when exiting the group.
5236 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
5238 @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
5239 If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
5240 from the next group.
5243 @node Article Caching
5244 @section Article Caching
5245 @cindex article caching
5248 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @sc{nntp} connection, you may
5249 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
5250 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
5251 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
5252 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
5254 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
5256 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
5257 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
5258 @vindex gnus-use-cache
5259 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
5260 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
5261 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
5262 cache is flat or hierarchal is controlled by the
5263 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
5265 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
5266 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
5267 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
5268 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
5269 as dormant, and don't worry.
5271 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
5273 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
5274 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
5275 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
5276 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
5277 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
5278 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
5279 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
5280 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
5281 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
5282 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
5284 @findex gnus-jog-cache
5285 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
5286 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
5287 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
5288 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
5289 command if 1) your connection to the @sc{nntp} server is really, really,
5290 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
5291 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
5292 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
5293 not then be downloaded by this command.
5295 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
5296 It is likely that you do not want caching on some groups. For instance,
5297 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
5298 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
5299 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space. To limit the caching,
5300 you could set the @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to
5301 @samp{^nnml}, for instance. This variable is @code{nil} by
5304 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
5305 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
5306 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
5307 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
5308 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
5309 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, gnus
5310 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
5311 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @sc{nov}
5312 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
5316 @node Persistent Articles
5317 @section Persistent Articles
5318 @cindex persistent articles
5320 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
5321 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
5322 useful in my opinion.
5324 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
5325 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
5326 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
5327 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
5328 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
5329 the expiry going on at the news server.
5331 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
5332 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
5333 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
5339 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
5340 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
5343 @kindex M-* (Summary)
5344 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
5345 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
5346 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
5350 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
5352 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
5353 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
5354 interested in persistent articles:
5357 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
5361 @node Article Backlog
5362 @section Article Backlog
5364 @cindex article backlog
5366 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
5367 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
5368 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where gnus will buffer
5369 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
5370 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
5371 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
5372 that, turning the backlog on will slow gnus down a little bit, and
5373 increase memory usage some.
5375 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
5376 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, gnus will store
5377 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
5378 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, gnus will store
5379 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
5380 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
5381 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
5383 This variable is @code{nil} by default.
5386 @node Saving Articles
5387 @section Saving Articles
5388 @cindex saving articles
5390 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
5391 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
5392 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
5393 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
5394 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
5396 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
5397 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, gnus will not delete
5398 unwanted headers before saving the article.
5400 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
5401 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
5402 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
5403 deleted before saving.
5409 @kindex O o (Summary)
5411 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
5412 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
5413 Save the current article using the default article saver
5414 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
5417 @kindex O m (Summary)
5418 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
5419 Save the current article in mail format
5420 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
5423 @kindex O r (Summary)
5424 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
5425 Save the current article in rmail format
5426 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
5429 @kindex O f (Summary)
5430 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
5431 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
5432 Save the current article in plain file format
5433 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
5436 @kindex O F (Summary)
5437 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
5438 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
5439 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
5442 @kindex O b (Summary)
5443 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
5444 Save the current article body in plain file format
5445 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
5448 @kindex O h (Summary)
5449 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
5450 Save the current article in mh folder format
5451 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
5454 @kindex O v (Summary)
5455 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
5456 Save the current article in a VM folder
5457 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
5460 @kindex O p (Summary)
5461 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
5462 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
5463 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
5466 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
5467 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
5468 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
5469 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
5470 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
5471 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
5472 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
5473 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
5474 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
5475 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
5476 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
5477 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
5481 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
5482 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
5483 gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the four ready-made
5484 functions below, or you can create your own.
5488 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
5489 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
5490 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
5491 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
5492 This is the default format, @dfn{babyl}. Uses the function in the
5493 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
5494 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
5496 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
5497 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
5498 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
5499 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
5500 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
5501 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
5503 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
5504 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
5505 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
5506 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
5507 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
5508 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
5509 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
5511 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
5512 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
5513 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
5514 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
5515 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
5517 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
5518 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
5519 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
5520 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
5521 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
5524 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
5525 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
5526 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
5527 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
5528 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
5530 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
5531 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
5532 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
5533 reader to use this setting.
5536 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
5537 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
5538 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
5539 @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
5542 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
5543 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
5544 available functions that generate names:
5548 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
5549 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
5550 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
5552 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
5553 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
5554 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
5556 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
5557 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
5558 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
5560 @item gnus-plain-save-name
5561 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
5562 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
5565 @vindex gnus-split-methods
5566 You can have gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp
5567 into the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would
5568 like to save articles related to gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and
5569 articles related to VM in @code{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable
5573 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
5574 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
5575 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
5576 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
5579 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
5580 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
5581 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
5582 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
5583 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
5584 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
5585 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
5586 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
5587 called returns a string or a list of strings.
5589 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
5590 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
5591 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
5592 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
5594 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
5595 means that gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
5596 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file name.
5598 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
5599 lots of mail groups called things like
5600 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
5601 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
5602 following will do just that:
5605 (defun my-save-name (group)
5606 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
5607 (substring group (match-end 0))))
5609 (setq gnus-split-methods
5610 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
5615 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
5616 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
5617 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
5618 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
5619 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
5620 all the files in the top level directory
5621 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
5622 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
5623 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
5624 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
5626 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
5627 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
5628 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
5629 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
5630 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
5633 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
5637 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; to get a hierarchy
5638 (setq gnus-default-article-saver 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; no encoding
5641 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
5642 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
5643 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
5644 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
5647 @node Decoding Articles
5648 @section Decoding Articles
5649 @cindex decoding articles
5651 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
5652 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
5655 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
5656 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
5657 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
5658 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
5659 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
5660 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
5664 @cindex article series
5665 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
5666 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
5667 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
5668 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
5669 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
5671 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
5672 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
5673 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
5675 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, gnus
5676 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
5677 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
5679 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
5680 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
5681 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
5684 @node Uuencoded Articles
5685 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
5687 @cindex uuencoded articles
5692 @kindex X u (Summary)
5693 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
5694 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
5695 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
5698 @kindex X U (Summary)
5699 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
5700 Uudecodes and saves the current series
5701 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
5704 @kindex X v u (Summary)
5705 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
5706 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
5709 @kindex X v U (Summary)
5710 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
5711 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
5712 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
5716 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
5717 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
5718 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
5719 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
5720 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
5722 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
5723 @sc{GNUS 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
5724 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
5725 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
5728 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
5729 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
5730 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
5731 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
5732 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
5733 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
5737 @node Shell Archives
5738 @subsection Shell Archives
5740 @cindex shell archives
5741 @cindex shared articles
5743 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
5744 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
5745 some commands to deal with these:
5750 @kindex X s (Summary)
5751 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
5752 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
5755 @kindex X S (Summary)
5756 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
5757 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
5760 @kindex X v s (Summary)
5761 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
5762 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
5765 @kindex X v S (Summary)
5766 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
5767 Unshars, views and saves the current series
5768 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
5772 @node PostScript Files
5773 @subsection PostScript Files
5779 @kindex X p (Summary)
5780 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
5781 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
5784 @kindex X P (Summary)
5785 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
5786 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
5787 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
5790 @kindex X v p (Summary)
5791 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
5792 View the current PostScript series
5793 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
5796 @kindex X v P (Summary)
5797 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
5798 View and save the current PostScript series
5799 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
5804 @subsection Other Files
5808 @kindex X o (Summary)
5809 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
5810 Save the current series
5811 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
5814 @kindex X b (Summary)
5815 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
5816 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
5817 doesn't really work yet.
5821 @node Decoding Variables
5822 @subsection Decoding Variables
5824 Adjective, not verb.
5827 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
5828 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
5829 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
5833 @node Rule Variables
5834 @subsubsection Rule Variables
5835 @cindex rule variables
5837 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
5838 variables are of the form
5841 (list '(regexp1 command2)
5848 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
5849 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
5851 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
5852 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @samp{.au} sound file, you could
5855 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
5856 (list '(\"\\\\.au$\" \"sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio\")))
5859 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
5860 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
5861 This variable is consulted if gnus couldn't make any matches from the
5862 user and default view rules.
5864 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
5865 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
5866 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
5871 @node Other Decode Variables
5872 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
5875 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
5877 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
5878 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
5879 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
5880 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
5881 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
5885 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
5886 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
5889 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
5890 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
5891 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
5894 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
5895 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
5896 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
5897 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
5898 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
5901 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
5902 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
5903 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
5905 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
5906 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
5907 Files with a @sc{mime} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
5908 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
5909 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @sc{mime} package (yet), so this is slightly
5912 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
5913 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
5914 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
5916 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
5917 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
5918 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
5919 looking for files to display.
5921 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
5922 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
5923 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
5926 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
5927 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
5928 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
5931 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
5932 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
5933 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
5936 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
5937 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
5938 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
5941 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
5942 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
5943 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
5944 decoded articles as unread.
5946 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
5947 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
5948 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
5949 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
5951 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
5952 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
5953 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
5955 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
5956 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
5958 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
5959 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @sc{mime}
5960 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
5961 @code{metamail} for viewing.
5963 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
5964 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
5965 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
5966 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
5967 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
5968 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC1153---no easy way
5969 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
5970 simply dropped them.
5975 @node Uuencoding and Posting
5976 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
5980 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
5981 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
5982 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
5983 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
5984 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
5985 for you when you post the article.
5987 @item gnus-uu-post-length
5988 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
5989 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
5990 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
5992 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
5993 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
5994 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
5995 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
5996 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
5997 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
5998 think that counts...) Default is @code{nil}.
6000 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
6001 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
6002 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
6003 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
6004 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
6005 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
6006 Default is @code{t}.
6012 @subsection Viewing Files
6013 @cindex viewing files
6014 @cindex pseudo-articles
6016 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, gnus will attempt
6017 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
6018 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
6019 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, gnus will
6020 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
6021 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
6022 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
6024 Finally, gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
6025 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
6026 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
6027 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
6029 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
6030 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
6031 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
6033 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
6034 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
6035 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
6036 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
6037 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
6039 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
6040 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
6041 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
6042 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
6043 a list of parameters to that command.
6045 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
6046 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
6047 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
6049 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
6050 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
6051 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
6054 @node Article Treatment
6055 @section Article Treatment
6057 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
6058 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
6059 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
6060 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
6061 these articles easier.
6064 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
6065 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
6066 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
6067 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
6068 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
6069 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
6070 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
6074 @node Article Highlighting
6075 @subsection Article Highlighting
6078 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
6079 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
6084 @kindex W H a (Summary)
6085 @findex gnus-article-highlight
6086 Highlight the current article (@code{gnus-article-highlight}).
6089 @kindex W H h (Summary)
6090 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
6091 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
6092 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
6093 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
6094 variable, which is a list where each element has the form @var{(regexp
6095 name content)}. @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
6096 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
6097 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
6098 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
6099 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
6102 @kindex W H c (Summary)
6103 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
6104 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
6106 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
6109 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
6111 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
6112 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
6113 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
6115 @item gnus-cite-prefix-regexp
6116 @vindex gnus-cite-prefix-regexp
6117 Regexp matching the longest possible citation prefix on a line.
6119 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
6120 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
6121 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
6123 @item gnus-cite-face-list
6124 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
6125 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
6126 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
6127 gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
6128 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
6130 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
6131 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
6132 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
6134 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
6135 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
6136 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
6138 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
6139 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
6140 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
6141 that it's a citation.
6143 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
6144 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
6145 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
6147 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
6148 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
6149 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
6151 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
6152 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
6153 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
6154 cited text belonging to the attribution.
6160 @kindex W H s (Summary)
6161 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
6162 @vindex gnus-signature-face
6163 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
6164 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
6165 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
6166 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
6167 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
6173 @node Article Fontisizing
6174 @subsection Article Fontisizing
6176 @cindex article emphasis
6178 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
6179 @kindex W e (Summary)
6180 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
6181 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*}. Gnus can make this look nicer by
6182 running the article through the @kbd{W e}
6183 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
6185 @vindex gnus-article-emphasis
6186 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
6187 @code{gnus-article-emphasis} variable. This is an alist where the first
6188 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
6189 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
6190 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
6191 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
6192 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
6196 (setq gnus-article-emphasis
6197 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
6198 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
6201 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
6202 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
6203 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
6204 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
6205 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
6206 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
6207 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
6208 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
6209 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
6210 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
6211 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
6212 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
6213 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
6215 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
6216 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
6217 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
6221 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
6225 @node Article Hiding
6226 @subsection Article Hiding
6227 @cindex article hiding
6229 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
6230 too much cruft in most articles.
6235 @kindex W W a (Summary)
6236 @findex gnus-article-hide
6237 Do maximum hiding on the summary buffer (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}).
6240 @kindex W W h (Summary)
6241 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
6242 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
6246 @kindex W W b (Summary)
6247 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
6248 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
6249 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
6252 @kindex W W s (Summary)
6253 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
6254 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
6258 @kindex W W p (Summary)
6259 @findex gnus-article-hide-pgp
6260 @vindex gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
6261 Hide @sc{pgp} signatures (@code{gnus-article-hide-pgp}). The
6262 @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook} hook will be run after a @sc{pgp}
6263 signature has been hidden.
6266 @kindex W W P (Summary)
6267 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
6268 Hide @sc{pem} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
6269 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
6272 @kindex W W c (Summary)
6273 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
6274 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
6275 customizing the hiding:
6279 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
6280 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
6281 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
6282 50), hide the cited text.
6284 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
6285 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
6286 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
6289 @item gnus-cited-text-button-line-format
6290 @vindex gnus-cited-text-button-line-format
6291 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
6292 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
6293 by this format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
6298 Start point of the hidden text.
6300 End point of the hidden text.
6302 Length of the hidden text.
6305 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
6306 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
6307 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave shown.
6312 @kindex W W C (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
6314 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
6315 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
6316 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
6317 in @code{gnus-article-display-hook} (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
6321 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
6322 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
6323 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
6325 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
6326 citation customization.
6329 @node Article Washing
6330 @subsection Article Washing
6332 @cindex article washing
6334 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
6335 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
6337 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
6338 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
6344 @kindex W l (Summary)
6345 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
6346 Remove page breaks from the current article
6347 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article} for page
6351 @kindex W r (Summary)
6352 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
6353 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
6354 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
6355 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
6356 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
6357 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
6359 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
6360 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
6361 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
6362 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
6365 @kindex W t (Summary)
6366 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
6367 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
6368 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
6371 @kindex W v (Summary)
6372 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-header
6373 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
6374 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-header}).
6377 @kindex W m (Summary)
6378 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-mime
6379 Toggle whether to display the article as @sc{mime} message
6380 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-mime}).
6383 @kindex W o (Summary)
6384 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
6385 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
6388 @kindex W d (Summary)
6389 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
6390 Treat M******** sm*rtq**t*s (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}).
6393 @kindex W w (Summary)
6394 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
6395 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}). If you use this
6396 function in @code{gnus-article-display-hook}, it should be run fairly
6397 late and certainly after any highlighting.
6399 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
6403 @kindex W c (Summary)
6404 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
6405 Remove CR (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines)
6406 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
6409 @kindex W f (Summary)
6411 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
6412 @findex gnus-article-x-face-command
6413 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
6414 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
6420 Look for and display any X-Face headers
6421 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}). The command executed by this
6422 function is given by the @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable.
6423 If this variable is a string, this string will be executed in a
6424 sub-shell. If it is a function, this function will be called with the
6425 face as the argument. If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which
6426 is a regexp) matches the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
6427 The default action under Emacs is to fork off an @code{xv} to view the
6428 face; under XEmacs the default action is to display the face before the
6429 @code{From} header. (It's nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with X-Face
6430 support---that will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native
6431 X-Face support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
6432 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends.) If you
6433 want to have this function in the display hook, it should probably come
6437 @kindex W b (Summary)
6438 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
6439 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
6440 @xref{Article Buttons}
6443 @kindex W B (Summary)
6444 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
6445 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
6446 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
6449 @kindex W E l (Summary)
6450 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
6451 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
6452 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
6455 @kindex W E m (Summary)
6456 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
6457 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
6458 lines with a single empty line.
6459 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
6462 @kindex W E t (Summary)
6463 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
6464 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
6465 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
6468 @kindex W E a (Summary)
6469 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
6470 Do all the three commands above
6471 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
6474 @kindex W E A (Summary)
6475 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
6476 Remove all blank lines
6477 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
6480 @kindex W E s (Summary)
6481 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
6482 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
6483 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
6488 @node Article Buttons
6489 @subsection Article Buttons
6492 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
6493 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
6494 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
6495 button on these references.
6497 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
6498 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses and Message-IDs. This is controlled by
6499 two variables, one that handles article bodies and one that handles
6504 @item gnus-button-alist
6505 @vindex gnus-button-alist
6506 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
6509 (REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
6515 All text that match this regular expression will be considered an
6516 external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches embedded URLs:
6517 @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}.
6520 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
6521 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
6522 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
6525 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
6526 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
6527 avoid false matches.
6530 This function will be called when you click on this button.
6533 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
6534 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
6538 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
6541 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
6544 @item gnus-header-button-alist
6545 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
6546 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
6547 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
6548 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
6551 (HEADER REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
6554 @var{HEADER} is a regular expression.
6556 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
6557 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
6558 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
6559 default values of the variables above.
6561 @item gnus-article-button-face
6562 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
6563 Face used on buttons.
6565 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
6566 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
6567 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
6573 @subsection Article Date
6575 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
6576 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
6577 when the article was sent.
6582 @kindex W T u (Summary)
6583 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
6584 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
6585 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
6588 @kindex W T i (Summary)
6589 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
6591 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
6592 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
6595 @kindex W T l (Summary)
6596 @findex gnus-article-date-local
6597 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
6600 @kindex W T s (Summary)
6601 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
6602 @findex gnus-article-date-user
6603 @findex format-time-string
6604 Display the date using a user-defined format
6605 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
6606 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
6607 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
6608 for a list of possible format specs.
6611 @kindex W T e (Summary)
6612 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
6613 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
6614 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
6615 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
6616 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). If you want to have this line
6617 updated continually, you can put
6620 (gnus-start-date-timer)
6623 in your @file{.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
6624 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
6628 @kindex W T o (Summary)
6629 @findex gnus-article-date-original
6630 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
6631 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
6632 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
6633 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
6634 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
6639 @node Article Signature
6640 @subsection Article Signature
6642 @cindex article signature
6644 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
6645 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
6646 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
6647 that says what is to be considered a signature is
6648 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
6649 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
6650 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
6651 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
6652 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
6655 (setq gnus-signature-separator
6656 '("^-- $" ; The standard
6657 "^-- *$" ; A common mangling
6658 "^-------*$" ; Many people just use a looong
6659 ; line of dashes. Shame!
6660 "^ *--------*$" ; Double-shame!
6661 "^________*$" ; Underscores are also popular
6662 "^========*$")) ; Pervert!
6665 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
6668 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
6669 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
6674 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
6677 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
6680 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
6681 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
6683 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
6684 in question is not a signature.
6687 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
6688 listed above. Here's an example:
6691 (setq gnus-signature-limit
6692 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
6695 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
6696 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
6697 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
6698 signature after all.
6701 @node Article Commands
6702 @section Article Commands
6709 @kindex A P (Summary)
6710 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
6711 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
6712 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
6713 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will be
6714 run just before printing the buffer.
6719 @node Summary Sorting
6720 @section Summary Sorting
6721 @cindex summary sorting
6723 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
6724 can't really see why you'd want that.
6729 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
6730 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
6731 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
6734 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
6735 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
6736 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
6739 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
6740 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
6741 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
6744 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
6745 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
6746 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
6749 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
6750 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
6751 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
6754 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
6755 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
6756 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
6759 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
6760 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
6761 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
6762 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
6763 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
6767 @node Finding the Parent
6768 @section Finding the Parent
6769 @cindex parent articles
6770 @cindex referring articles
6775 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
6776 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
6777 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
6778 if the current group is fetched by @sc{nntp}, the parent hasn't expired
6779 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
6780 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
6781 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
6782 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
6783 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
6785 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
6786 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
6787 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, gnus will fetch the parent, the
6788 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
6789 @kbd{-3 ^}, gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
6793 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
6794 @kindex A R (Summary)
6795 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
6796 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
6799 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
6800 @kindex A T (Summary)
6801 Display the full thread where the current article appears
6802 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
6803 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
6804 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
6805 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
6806 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
6807 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
6809 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
6810 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
6811 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
6812 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
6813 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
6814 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
6817 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
6818 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
6820 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
6821 You can also ask the @sc{nntp} server for an arbitrary article, no
6822 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
6823 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
6824 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
6825 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
6826 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
6829 The current select method will be used when fetching by
6830 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
6831 by giving this command a prefix.
6833 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
6834 If the group you are reading is located on a backend that does not
6835 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
6836 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @sc{nntp} method. It
6837 would, perhaps, be best if the @sc{nntp} server you consult is the one
6838 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
6841 Most of the mail backends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but do
6842 not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox} and
6843 @code{nnbabyl} are able to locate articles from any groups, while
6844 @code{nnml} and @code{nnfolder} are only able to locate articles that
6845 have been posted to the current group. (Anything else would be too time
6846 consuming.) @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
6849 @node Alternative Approaches
6850 @section Alternative Approaches
6852 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
6853 gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
6856 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
6857 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
6862 @subsection Pick and Read
6863 @cindex pick and read
6865 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
6866 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
6867 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
6868 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
6870 @findex gnus-pick-mode
6871 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
6872 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
6873 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
6874 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
6875 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
6877 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
6882 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
6883 Pick the article or thread on the current line
6884 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
6885 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
6886 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
6887 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
6888 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
6889 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
6892 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
6893 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
6894 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
6895 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
6899 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
6900 Unpick the thread or article
6901 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
6902 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
6903 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
6904 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
6905 the thread or article at that line.
6909 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
6910 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
6911 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
6912 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
6913 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
6914 will still be visible when you are reading.
6918 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
6919 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
6920 which is mapped to the same function
6921 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
6923 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
6926 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
6929 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
6930 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
6932 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
6933 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
6934 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
6936 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
6937 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
6938 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
6939 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
6940 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
6941 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
6942 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
6946 @subsection Binary Groups
6947 @cindex binary groups
6949 @findex gnus-binary-mode
6950 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
6951 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
6952 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
6953 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
6954 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
6955 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
6958 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
6959 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
6960 command, when you have turned on this mode
6961 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
6963 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
6964 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
6968 @section Tree Display
6971 @vindex gnus-use-trees
6972 If you don't like the normal gnus summary display, you might try setting
6973 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
6974 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
6977 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
6980 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
6981 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
6982 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
6984 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
6985 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
6986 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
6987 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
6988 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
6990 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
6991 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
6992 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
6993 default is @code{modeline}.
6995 @item gnus-tree-line-format
6996 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
6997 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
6998 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
6999 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
7000 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
7001 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
7007 The name of the poster.
7009 The @code{From} header.
7011 The number of the article.
7013 The opening bracket.
7015 The closing bracket.
7020 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
7022 Variables related to the display are:
7025 @item gnus-tree-brackets
7026 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
7027 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
7028 ``sparse'' articles. The format is @var{((real-open . real-close)
7029 (sparse-open . sparse-close) (dummy-open . dummy-close))}, and the
7030 default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
7032 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
7033 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
7034 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
7035 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
7039 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
7040 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
7041 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, gnus will try to keep the tree
7042 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other gnus
7043 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
7044 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
7045 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
7046 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
7047 other windows displayed next to it.
7049 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
7050 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
7051 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
7052 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
7053 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
7054 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
7055 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
7059 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
7062 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
7072 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
7076 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
7077 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
7079 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
7081 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
7086 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
7087 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
7088 following to your @file{.gnus.el} file:
7091 (setq gnus-use-trees t
7092 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
7093 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
7094 (gnus-add-configuration
7098 (summary 0.75 point)
7103 @xref{Windows Configuration}.
7106 @node Mail Group Commands
7107 @section Mail Group Commands
7108 @cindex mail group commands
7110 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
7111 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
7113 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
7114 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
7119 @kindex B e (Summary)
7120 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
7121 Expire all expirable articles in the group
7122 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}).
7125 @kindex B M-C-e (Summary)
7126 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
7127 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
7128 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
7129 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
7130 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
7133 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
7134 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
7135 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
7136 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
7137 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
7138 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
7141 @kindex B m (Summary)
7143 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
7144 Move the article from one mail group to another
7145 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}).
7148 @kindex B c (Summary)
7150 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
7151 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
7152 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
7153 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}).
7156 @kindex B B (Summary)
7157 @cindex crosspost mail
7158 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
7159 Crosspost the current article to some other group
7160 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
7161 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
7162 be properly updated.
7165 @kindex B i (Summary)
7166 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
7167 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
7168 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
7169 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
7172 @kindex B r (Summary)
7173 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
7174 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}).
7175 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
7176 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
7177 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
7181 @kindex B w (Summary)
7183 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
7184 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
7185 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
7186 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
7187 (@kbd{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
7188 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, gnus won't re-highlight the article.
7191 @kindex B q (Summary)
7192 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
7193 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
7194 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
7195 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
7198 @kindex B t (Summary)
7199 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
7200 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
7201 when repooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
7204 @kindex B p (Summary)
7205 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
7206 Some people have a tendency to send you "courtesy" copies when they
7207 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
7208 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
7209 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
7210 article from your news server (or rather, from
7211 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
7212 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
7213 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
7214 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
7215 just not have arrived yet.
7219 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
7220 @cindex moving articles
7221 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have gnus
7222 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
7223 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
7224 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
7225 suggestions you find reasonable.
7228 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
7229 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
7230 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
7231 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
7235 @node Various Summary Stuff
7236 @section Various Summary Stuff
7239 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
7240 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
7241 * Summary Generation Commands:: (Re)generating the summary buffer.
7242 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
7246 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
7247 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
7248 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
7250 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
7251 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
7252 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
7253 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
7254 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
7255 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
7258 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
7259 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
7260 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
7261 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
7262 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
7264 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
7265 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
7266 When gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
7267 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
7268 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
7269 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
7270 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), gnus will rename the
7271 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
7272 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
7273 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
7278 @node Summary Group Information
7279 @subsection Summary Group Information
7284 @kindex H f (Summary)
7285 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
7286 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
7287 Try to fetch the FAQ (list of frequently asked questions) for the
7288 current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the
7289 FAQ from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory
7290 on a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
7291 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
7292 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will probably
7293 be used for fetching the file.
7296 @kindex H d (Summary)
7297 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
7298 Give a brief description of the current group
7299 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
7300 rereading the description from the server.
7303 @kindex H h (Summary)
7304 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
7305 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
7306 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
7309 @kindex H i (Summary)
7310 @findex gnus-info-find-node
7311 Go to the gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
7315 @node Searching for Articles
7316 @subsection Searching for Articles
7321 @kindex M-s (Summary)
7322 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
7323 Search through all subsequent articles for a regexp
7324 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
7327 @kindex M-r (Summary)
7328 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
7329 Search through all previous articles for a regexp
7330 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
7334 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
7335 This command will prompt you for a header field, a regular expression to
7336 match on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
7337 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If given a prefix, search
7341 @kindex M-& (Summary)
7342 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
7343 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
7344 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
7347 @node Summary Generation Commands
7348 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
7353 @kindex Y g (Summary)
7354 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
7355 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
7358 @kindex Y c (Summary)
7359 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
7360 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
7361 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
7366 @node Really Various Summary Commands
7367 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
7372 @kindex C-d (Summary)
7373 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
7374 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
7375 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
7376 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
7377 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
7378 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
7379 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
7380 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
7384 @kindex M-C-d (Summary)
7385 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
7386 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
7387 several documents into one biiig group
7388 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
7389 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
7390 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
7391 command understands the process/prefix convention
7392 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
7395 @kindex C-t (Summary)
7396 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
7397 Toggle truncation of summary lines
7398 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
7399 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
7400 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
7404 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
7405 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
7406 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
7409 @kindex M-C-e (Summary)
7410 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
7411 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
7412 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
7417 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
7418 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
7419 @cindex summary exit
7420 @cindex exiting groups
7422 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
7423 group and return you to the group buffer.
7429 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
7431 @findex gnus-summary-exit
7432 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
7433 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
7434 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
7435 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
7436 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
7437 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
7438 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
7439 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
7440 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
7441 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
7445 @kindex Z E (Summary)
7447 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
7448 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
7449 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
7453 @kindex Z c (Summary)
7455 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
7456 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
7457 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
7458 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
7461 @kindex Z C (Summary)
7462 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
7463 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
7464 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
7467 @kindex Z n (Summary)
7468 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
7469 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
7470 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
7473 @kindex Z R (Summary)
7474 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
7475 Exit this group, and then enter it again
7476 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
7477 all articles, both read and unread.
7481 @kindex Z G (Summary)
7482 @kindex M-g (Summary)
7483 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
7484 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
7485 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
7486 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
7487 articles, both read and unread.
7490 @kindex Z N (Summary)
7491 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
7492 Exit the group and go to the next group
7493 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
7496 @kindex Z P (Summary)
7497 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
7498 Exit the group and go to the previous group
7499 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
7502 @kindex Z s (Summary)
7503 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
7504 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
7505 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
7506 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
7507 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
7510 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
7511 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current
7514 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
7515 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
7516 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
7517 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
7518 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
7519 If you do that, gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
7520 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
7521 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
7522 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
7523 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
7524 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
7525 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
7527 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
7529 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
7530 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
7531 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
7532 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
7533 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
7534 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
7535 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
7536 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
7537 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
7540 @node Crosspost Handling
7541 @section Crosspost Handling
7545 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
7546 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
7547 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
7548 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
7549 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
7550 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
7553 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
7554 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
7555 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
7556 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
7557 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
7559 @cindex cross-posting
7562 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
7563 correctly is if you use an @sc{nntp} server that supports @sc{xover}
7564 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
7565 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @sc{nov} lines. This is
7566 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
7567 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
7568 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
7569 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
7570 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
7571 the cross reference mechanism.
7573 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
7574 @cindex overview.fmt
7575 To check whether your @sc{nntp} server includes the @code{Xref} header
7576 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
7577 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
7578 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
7579 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
7580 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
7583 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
7584 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
7585 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
7590 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
7593 @node Duplicate Suppression
7594 @section Duplicate Suppression
7596 By default, gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
7597 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
7598 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
7599 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various reasons.
7603 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
7604 is evil and not very common.
7607 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
7608 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
7611 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
7612 different @sc{nntp} servers.
7615 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
7618 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
7619 well, but these four are the most common situations.
7621 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
7622 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
7623 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
7624 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
7625 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
7626 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
7627 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
7630 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
7631 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
7632 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
7633 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
7634 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
7638 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
7639 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
7640 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
7642 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
7643 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
7644 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
7645 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
7646 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single gnus
7647 session are suppressed.
7649 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
7650 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
7651 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
7652 suppression list. The default is 10000.
7654 @item gnus-duplicate-file
7655 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
7656 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
7657 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
7660 If you have a tendency to stop and start gnus often, setting
7661 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
7662 you leave gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
7663 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
7664 so that means that if you stop and start gnus often, you should set
7665 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
7666 to you to figure out, I think.
7669 @node The Article Buffer
7670 @chapter The Article Buffer
7671 @cindex article buffer
7673 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
7674 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
7675 tell gnus otherwise.
7678 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
7679 * Using MIME:: Pushing to mime articles as @sc{mime} messages.
7680 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
7681 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
7682 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
7686 @node Hiding Headers
7687 @section Hiding Headers
7688 @cindex hiding headers
7689 @cindex deleting headers
7691 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
7692 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
7694 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
7695 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
7696 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
7697 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
7698 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
7699 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
7700 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseum---and you'll probably want to get rid
7701 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
7702 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
7704 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
7708 @item gnus-visible-headers
7709 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
7710 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
7711 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
7712 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
7714 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
7715 the article and the subject, you'd say:
7718 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
7721 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
7724 @item gnus-ignored-headers
7725 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
7726 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
7727 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
7728 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
7729 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
7731 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} field
7732 and the @code{Xref} field, you might say:
7735 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
7738 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
7741 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
7742 variable will have no effect.
7746 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
7747 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
7748 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
7749 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
7750 the headers are to be displayed.
7752 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
7753 and then the subject, you might say something like:
7756 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
7759 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
7760 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed
7763 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
7764 @vindex gnus-article-display-hook
7765 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
7766 You can hide further boring headers by entering
7767 @code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers} into
7768 @code{gnus-article-display-hook}. What this function does depends on
7769 the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a list, but this
7770 list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead is lists various
7771 @dfn{boring conditions} that gnus can check and remove from sight.
7773 These conditions are:
7776 Remove all empty headers.
7778 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
7781 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
7782 @code{Newsgroups} header.
7784 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same address as the
7787 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
7790 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
7792 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
7795 To include the four first elements, you could say something like;
7798 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
7799 '(empty newsgroups followup-to reply-to))
7802 This is also the default value for this variable.
7806 @section Using @sc{mime}
7809 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
7810 while people stand around yawning.
7812 @sc{mime}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
7813 while all newsreaders die of fear.
7815 @sc{mime} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
7816 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
7817 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
7819 @vindex gnus-show-mime
7820 @vindex gnus-article-display-method-for-mime
7821 @vindex gnus-strict-mime
7822 @findex gnus-article-display-mime-message
7823 Gnus handles @sc{mime} by pushing the articles through
7824 @code{gnus-article-display-method-for-mime}, which is
7825 @code{gnus-article-display-mime-message} by default. This function
7826 calls the SEMI MIME-View program to actually do the work. For more
7827 information on SEMI MIME-View, see its manual page (however it is not
7828 existed yet, sorry).
7830 Set @code{gnus-show-mime} to @code{t} if you want to use
7831 @sc{mime} all the time. However, if @code{gnus-strict-mime} is
7832 non-@code{nil}, the @sc{mime} method will only be used if there are
7833 @sc{mime} headers in the article. If you have @code{gnus-show-mime}
7834 set, then you'll see some unfortunate display glitches in the article
7835 buffer. These can't be avoided.
7837 In GNUS or Gnus, it might be best to just use the toggling functions
7838 from the summary buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance,
7839 you enter the group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it,
7840 @sc{mime} has decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible
7841 sing-a-long song comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find
7842 the volume button, because there isn't one, and people are starting to
7843 look at you, and you try to stop the program, but you can't, and you
7844 can't find the program to control the volume, and everybody else in the
7845 room suddenly decides to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel
7848 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
7850 To avoid such kind of situation, gnus stops to use
7851 @code{metamail-buffer}. So now, you can set @code{gnus-show-mime} to
7852 non-@code{nil} every-time, then you can push button in the article
7853 buffer when there are nobody else.
7856 @node Customizing Articles
7857 @section Customizing Articles
7858 @cindex article customization
7860 @vindex gnus-article-display-hook
7861 The @code{gnus-article-display-hook} is called after the article has
7862 been inserted into the article buffer. It is meant to handle all
7863 treatment of the article before it is displayed.
7865 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
7866 By default this hook just contains @code{gnus-article-hide-headers},
7867 @code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}, and
7868 @code{gnus-article-maybe-highlight}, but there are thousands, nay
7869 millions, of functions you can put in this hook. For an overview of
7870 functions @pxref{Article Highlighting}, @pxref{Article Hiding},
7871 @pxref{Article Washing}, @pxref{Article Buttons} and @pxref{Article
7872 Date}. Note that the order of functions in this hook might affect
7873 things, so you may have to fiddle a bit to get the desired results.
7875 You can, of course, write your own functions. The functions are called
7876 from the article buffer, and you can do anything you like, pretty much.
7877 There is no information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can
7878 change everything. However, you shouldn't delete any headers. Instead
7879 make them invisible if you want to make them go away.
7882 @node Article Keymap
7883 @section Article Keymap
7885 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
7886 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
7887 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
7888 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
7891 A few additional keystrokes are available:
7896 @kindex SPACE (Article)
7897 @findex gnus-article-next-page
7898 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
7901 @kindex DEL (Article)
7902 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
7903 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
7906 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
7907 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
7908 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
7909 @kbd{C-c ^}, gnus will try to get that article from the server
7910 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
7913 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
7914 @findex gnus-article-mail
7915 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
7916 given a prefix, include the mail.
7920 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
7921 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
7922 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
7926 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
7927 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
7928 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
7931 @kindex TAB (Article)
7932 @findex gnus-article-next-button
7933 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
7934 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
7937 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
7938 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
7939 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
7945 @section Misc Article
7949 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
7950 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
7951 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
7952 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
7955 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
7956 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
7957 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
7958 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
7959 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
7960 the contents of the article buffer.
7962 @vindex gnus-article-display-hook
7963 @item gnus-article-display-hook
7964 This hook is called as the last thing when displaying an article, and is
7965 intended for modifying the contents of the buffer, doing highlights,
7966 hiding headers, and the like.
7968 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
7969 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
7970 Hook called in article mode buffers.
7972 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
7973 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
7974 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
7975 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
7977 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
7978 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
7979 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
7980 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
7981 accepts the same format specifications as that variable, with one
7986 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
7987 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
7991 @vindex gnus-break-pages
7993 @item gnus-break-pages
7994 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
7995 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
7996 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
7997 paging will not be done.
7999 @item gnus-page-delimiter
8000 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
8001 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
8006 @node Composing Messages
8007 @chapter Composing Messages
8008 @cindex composing messages
8011 @cindex sending mail
8016 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
8017 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
8018 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the article
8019 by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Top, message, The Message
8020 Manual}. If you are in a foreign news group, and you wish to post the
8021 article using the foreign server, you can give a prefix to @kbd{C-c C-c}
8022 to make gnus try to post using the foreign server.
8025 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
8026 * Post:: Posting and following up.
8027 * Posting Server:: What server should you post via?
8028 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
8029 * Archived Messages:: Where gnus stores the messages you've sent.
8030 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
8031 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
8032 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
8035 Also see @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
8036 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
8042 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
8045 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
8046 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
8047 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
8048 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched.
8050 @item gnus-add-to-list
8051 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
8052 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
8053 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
8061 Variables for composing news articles:
8064 @item gnus-sent-message-ids-file
8065 @vindex gnus-sent-message-ids-file
8066 Gnus will keep a @code{Message-ID} history file of all the mails it has
8067 sent. If it discovers that it has already sent a mail, it will ask the
8068 user whether to re-send the mail. (This is primarily useful when
8069 dealing with @sc{soup} packets and the like where one is apt to send the
8070 same packet multiple times.) This variable says what the name of this
8071 history file is. It is @file{~/News/Sent-Message-IDs} by default. Set
8072 this variable to @code{nil} if you don't want gnus to keep a history
8075 @item gnus-sent-message-ids-length
8076 @vindex gnus-sent-message-ids-length
8077 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the history
8078 file. It is 1000 by default.
8083 @node Posting Server
8084 @section Posting Server
8086 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
8087 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
8089 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
8091 @vindex gnus-post-method
8093 It can be quite complicated. Normally, gnus will use the same native
8094 server. However. If your native server doesn't allow posting, just
8095 reading, you probably want to use some other server to post your
8096 (extremely intelligent and fabulously interesting) articles. You can
8097 then set the @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
8100 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
8103 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
8104 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
8105 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
8106 the ``current'' server for posting.
8108 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
8109 gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
8111 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
8112 If that's the case, gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
8115 Finally, if you want to always post using the same select method as
8116 you're reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
8117 groups from different private servers), you can set this variable to
8122 @section Mail and Post
8124 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
8128 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
8129 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
8130 @cindex mailing lists
8132 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
8133 gatewayed to the @sc{nntp} server, you can read those groups without
8134 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
8135 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
8136 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
8137 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
8138 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
8139 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
8140 still a pain, though.
8144 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
8145 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
8146 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
8149 @findex ispell-message
8151 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
8155 @node Archived Messages
8156 @section Archived Messages
8157 @cindex archived messages
8158 @cindex sent messages
8160 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
8161 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
8162 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
8163 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
8166 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
8167 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server gnus is to
8168 use to store sent messages. The default is:
8172 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
8173 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
8174 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
8175 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
8178 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
8179 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likeable select method
8180 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
8181 directory chosen, you could say something like:
8184 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
8185 '(nnfolder "archive"
8186 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
8187 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
8188 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
8191 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
8193 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
8194 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
8195 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
8197 This variable can be used to do the following:
8201 Messages will be saved in that group.
8202 @item a list of strings
8203 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
8204 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
8205 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
8207 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
8212 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
8214 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
8217 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
8219 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
8222 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
8224 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
8225 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
8226 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
8227 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
8232 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
8233 '((if (message-news-p)
8238 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
8239 messages in one file per month:
8242 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
8243 '((if (message-news-p)
8245 (concat "mail." (format-time-string
8246 "%Y-%m" (current-time))))))
8249 (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
8250 use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
8252 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
8253 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
8254 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
8255 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
8256 gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
8257 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
8258 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
8259 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
8260 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
8261 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
8263 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
8264 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
8265 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
8266 this will disable archiving.
8269 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
8270 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
8271 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
8272 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
8273 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
8276 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
8277 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
8278 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
8281 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
8282 but the latter is the preferred method.
8286 @node Posting Styles
8287 @section Posting Styles
8288 @cindex posting styles
8291 All them variables, they make my head swim.
8293 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
8294 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
8295 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
8298 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
8299 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
8300 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
8301 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
8302 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
8307 (signature "Peace and happiness")
8308 (organization "What me?"))
8310 (signature "Death to everybody"))
8311 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
8312 (organization "Emacs is it")))
8315 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
8316 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
8317 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
8318 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
8319 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
8320 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
8321 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
8322 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
8324 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
8325 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
8326 If it's a function symbol, that function will be called with no
8327 arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
8328 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
8329 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is said
8332 Each style may contain a arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
8333 attribute consists of a @var{(name . value)} pair. The attribute name
8334 can be one of @code{signature}, @code{signature-file},
8335 @code{organization}, @code{address} or @code{name}. The attribute name
8336 can also be a string. In that case, this will be used as a header name,
8337 and the value will be inserted in the headers of the article.
8339 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function (the
8340 return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used) or a
8341 list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be used).
8343 So here's a new example:
8346 (setq gnus-posting-styles
8348 (signature-file "~/.signature")
8350 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
8351 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
8353 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
8354 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly")
8355 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
8356 (posting-from-work-p
8357 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
8358 (address "user@@bar.foo")
8359 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
8361 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
8369 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
8370 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
8371 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
8372 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
8373 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
8375 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
8376 some sort using the gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
8377 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
8378 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
8379 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
8383 @vindex nndraft-directory
8384 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
8385 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
8386 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
8387 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
8388 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
8389 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
8391 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
8392 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
8395 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
8396 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
8397 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
8398 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
8399 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
8400 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
8401 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
8402 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
8403 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
8404 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
8405 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
8406 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
8407 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
8408 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
8410 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
8411 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
8412 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
8414 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
8416 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
8417 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
8418 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
8420 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
8423 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
8424 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
8425 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
8426 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
8427 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
8428 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
8429 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
8432 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
8433 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
8434 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
8437 @node Rejected Articles
8438 @section Rejected Articles
8439 @cindex rejected articles
8441 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
8442 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
8443 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
8444 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
8446 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of gnus.
8447 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
8448 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
8449 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So gnus saves these
8450 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
8452 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
8453 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
8454 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
8457 @node Select Methods
8458 @chapter Select Methods
8459 @cindex foreign groups
8460 @cindex select methods
8462 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
8463 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
8464 @sc{nntp} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
8465 personal mail group.
8467 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
8468 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
8469 list where the first element says what backend to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
8470 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
8471 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
8472 value may have special meaning for the backend in question.
8474 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
8475 we do just that (@pxref{The Server Buffer}).
8477 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the backend will recognize the
8480 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @sc{nntp} server
8481 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
8482 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
8483 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
8484 backend just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
8486 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
8489 * The Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
8490 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
8491 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
8492 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
8493 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
8494 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
8498 @node The Server Buffer
8499 @section The Server Buffer
8501 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
8502 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
8503 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
8504 one backend or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
8505 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
8506 backend represents a virtual server.
8508 For instance, the @code{nntp} backend may be used to connect to several
8509 different actual @sc{nntp} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
8510 on the same actual @sc{nntp} server. You tell Gnus which backend to
8511 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
8513 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
8514 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
8515 @sc{nntp} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
8516 hangs if queried for @sc{nov} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
8517 Anyways, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
8518 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
8519 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
8521 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
8522 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
8525 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
8526 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
8527 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
8528 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
8529 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
8530 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
8531 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
8534 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
8535 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
8538 @node Server Buffer Format
8539 @subsection Server Buffer Format
8540 @cindex server buffer format
8542 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
8543 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
8544 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
8545 variable, with some simple extensions:
8550 How the news is fetched---the backend name.
8553 The name of this server.
8556 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
8559 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
8562 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
8563 The mode line can also be customized by using the
8564 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
8565 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
8575 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
8578 @node Server Commands
8579 @subsection Server Commands
8580 @cindex server commands
8586 @findex gnus-server-add-server
8587 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
8591 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
8592 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
8595 @kindex SPACE (Server)
8596 @findex gnus-server-read-server
8597 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
8601 @findex gnus-server-exit
8602 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
8606 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
8607 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
8611 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
8612 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
8616 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
8617 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
8621 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
8622 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
8626 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
8627 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
8628 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
8633 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
8634 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
8635 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
8636 a mail backend that has gotten out of synch.
8641 @node Example Methods
8642 @subsection Example Methods
8644 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
8647 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
8650 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
8656 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
8657 backend, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
8660 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
8661 @var{(variable form)} pairs.
8663 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
8664 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
8668 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
8671 You should read the documentation to each backend to find out what
8672 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
8674 @code{nnmh} is a mail backend that reads a spool-like structure. Say
8675 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
8676 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
8680 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
8683 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
8686 Here's the method for a public spool:
8690 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
8691 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
8694 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @sc{nntp}
8695 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
8696 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @sc{nntp} server.
8697 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
8698 should probably look something like this:
8702 (nntp-address "the.firewall.machine")
8703 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-rlogin)
8704 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
8705 (nntp-rlogin-parameters
8706 ("telnet" "the.real.nntp.host" "nntp")))
8709 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
8710 compressed connection over the modem line, you could create a virtual
8711 server that would look something like this:
8715 (nntp-address "copper.uio.no")
8716 (nntp-rlogin-program "ssh")
8717 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-rlogin)
8718 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
8719 (nntp-rlogin-parameters
8720 ("telnet" "news.uio.no" "nntp")))
8723 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
8724 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
8725 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
8726 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
8729 @node Creating a Virtual Server
8730 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
8732 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
8733 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
8735 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
8736 would probably be best to use @code{nnspool} to read the cache. You
8737 could also use @code{nnml} or @code{nnmh}, though.
8739 Type @kbd{a nnspool RET cache RET}.
8741 You should now have a brand new @code{nnspool} virtual server called
8742 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
8743 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
8744 will contain the following:
8754 (nnspool-spool-directory "~/News/cache/")
8755 (nnspool-nov-directory "~/News/cache/")
8756 (nnspool-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
8759 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
8760 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
8761 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
8764 @node Server Variables
8765 @subsection Server Variables
8767 One sticky point when defining variables (both on backends and in Emacs
8768 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
8769 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
8770 change the "base" variable after the variables have been loaded, you
8771 won't change the "derived" variables.
8773 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
8774 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
8775 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
8776 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
8777 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
8778 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
8779 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
8780 variables for each backend, see each backend's section later in this
8781 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
8785 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
8786 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
8787 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
8791 @node Servers and Methods
8792 @subsection Servers and Methods
8794 Wherever you would normally use a select method
8795 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
8796 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
8797 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
8801 @node Unavailable Servers
8802 @subsection Unavailable Servers
8804 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
8805 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
8806 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
8807 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
8808 actually the case or not.
8810 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
8811 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
8812 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
8813 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
8814 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
8815 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
8816 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
8817 it will regard that server as ``down''.
8819 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
8820 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
8822 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{The Server Buffer}) and poke it
8823 with the following commands:
8829 @findex gnus-server-open-server
8830 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
8831 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
8835 @findex gnus-server-close-server
8836 Close the connection (if any) to the server
8837 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
8841 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
8842 Mark the current server as unreachable
8843 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
8846 @kindex M-o (Server)
8847 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
8848 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
8849 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
8852 @kindex M-c (Server)
8853 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
8854 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
8855 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
8859 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
8860 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
8861 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
8867 @section Getting News
8868 @cindex reading news
8869 @cindex news backends
8871 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
8872 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @sc{nntp} server,
8873 or it can read from a local spool.
8876 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
8877 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
8882 @subsection @sc{nntp}
8885 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @sc{nntp} server is rather easy.
8886 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @sc{nntp}
8887 server as the, uhm, address.
8889 If the @sc{nntp} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
8890 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
8891 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
8892 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
8894 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
8895 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
8896 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
8898 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
8903 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
8904 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
8905 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
8907 @cindex authentification
8908 @cindex nntp authentification
8909 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
8910 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
8911 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
8912 commands to the @sc{nntp} server after it has been contacted. By
8913 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
8914 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
8915 present in this hook.
8917 @item nntp-authinfo-function
8918 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
8919 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
8920 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
8921 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @sc{nntp}
8922 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
8923 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
8924 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
8925 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
8926 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
8927 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
8928 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
8932 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
8935 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs. The
8936 valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
8937 @samp{default} and @samp{force}. (The latter is not a valid
8938 @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} token, which is the only way the
8939 @file{.authinfo} file format deviates from the @file{.netrc} file
8944 Here's an example file:
8947 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
8948 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
8951 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
8952 have to be first, for instance.
8954 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
8955 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
8956 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
8957 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
8958 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
8959 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
8960 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
8962 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
8963 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
8969 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
8970 previously mentioned.
8972 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
8974 @item nntp-server-action-alist
8975 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
8976 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
8977 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
8978 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
8981 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
8985 You probably don't want to do that, though.
8987 The default value is
8990 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
8991 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
8994 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
8995 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
8997 @item nntp-maximum-request
8998 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
8999 If the @sc{nntp} server doesn't support @sc{nov} headers, this backend
9000 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
9001 speed things up, the backend sends lots of these commands without
9002 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
9003 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
9004 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
9006 @c @item nntp-connection-timeout
9007 @c @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
9008 @c If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
9009 @c regularly, you're sure to have problems with @sc{nntp} servers not
9010 @c responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
9011 @c time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
9012 @c somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
9013 @c that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} backend should wait for a
9014 @c connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
9015 @c no timeouts are done.
9017 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
9018 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
9019 @c @cindex PPP connections
9020 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
9021 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
9022 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
9023 @c changes after connecting to the @sc{nntp} server, Gnus will simply sit
9024 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
9025 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
9026 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
9027 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
9028 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
9029 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
9031 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
9032 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
9033 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
9034 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
9037 @item nntp-server-hook
9038 @vindex nntp-server-hook
9039 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @sc{nntp}
9042 @findex nntp-open-rlogin
9043 @findex nntp-open-telnet
9044 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
9045 @item nntp-open-connection-function
9046 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
9047 This function is used to connect to the remote system. Four pre-made
9048 functions are supplied:
9051 @item nntp-open-network-stream
9052 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
9055 @item nntp-open-rlogin
9056 Does an @samp{rlogin} on the
9057 remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet} to the @sc{nntp} server
9060 @code{nntp-open-rlogin}-related variables:
9064 @item nntp-rlogin-program
9065 @vindex nntp-rlogin-program
9066 Program used to log in on remote machines. The default is @samp{rsh},
9067 but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
9069 @item nntp-rlogin-parameters
9070 @vindex nntp-rlogin-parameters
9071 This list will be used as the parameter list given to @code{rsh}.
9073 @item nntp-rlogin-user-name
9074 @vindex nntp-rlogin-user-name
9075 User name on the remote system.
9079 @item nntp-open-telnet
9080 Does a @samp{telnet} to the remote system and then another @samp{telnet}
9081 to get to the @sc{nntp} server.
9083 @code{nntp-open-telnet}-related variables:
9086 @item nntp-telnet-command
9087 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
9088 Command used to start @code{telnet}.
9090 @item nntp-telnet-switches
9091 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
9092 List of strings to be used as the switches to the @code{telnet} command.
9094 @item nntp-telnet-user-name
9095 @vindex nntp-telnet-user-name
9096 User name for log in on the remote system.
9098 @item nntp-telnet-passwd
9099 @vindex nntp-telnet-passwd
9100 Password to use when logging in.
9102 @item nntp-telnet-parameters
9103 @vindex nntp-telnet-parameters
9104 A list of strings executed as a command after logging in
9107 @item nntp-telnet-shell-prompt
9108 @vindex nntp-telnet-shell-prompt
9109 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the remote machine. The default is
9110 @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
9112 @item nntp-open-telnet-envuser
9113 @vindex nntp-open-telnet-envuser
9114 If non-@code{nil}, the @code{telnet} session (client and server both)
9115 will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for login name.
9116 This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
9120 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
9121 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
9122 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use this
9123 you must have SSLay installed
9124 (@file{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL}, and you also need
9125 @file{ssl.el} (from the W3 distributeion, for instance). You then
9126 define a server as follows:
9129 ;; Type `C-c C-c' after you've finished editing.
9131 ;; "snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our /etc/services
9133 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
9134 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
9135 (nntp-port-number "snews")
9136 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
9141 @item nntp-end-of-line
9142 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
9143 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @sc{nntp}
9144 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
9145 using @code{rlogin} to talk to the server.
9147 @item nntp-rlogin-user-name
9148 @vindex nntp-rlogin-user-name
9149 User name on the remote system when using the @code{rlogin} connect
9153 @vindex nntp-address
9154 The address of the remote system running the @sc{nntp} server.
9156 @item nntp-port-number
9157 @vindex nntp-port-number
9158 Port number to connect to when using the @code{nntp-open-network-stream}
9161 @item nntp-buggy-select
9162 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
9163 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
9165 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
9166 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
9167 If the @sc{nntp} server does not support @sc{nov}, you could set this
9168 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @sc{nov}
9171 @item nntp-xover-commands
9172 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
9175 List of strings used as commands to fetch @sc{nov} lines from a
9176 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
9180 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
9181 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @sc{nov} lines to
9182 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
9183 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
9184 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @sc{nov}
9185 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
9186 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
9187 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
9188 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
9189 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
9190 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
9192 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
9193 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
9194 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @sc{nntp} server.
9196 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
9197 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
9198 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
9199 server closes connection.
9201 @item nntp-record-commands
9202 @vindex nntp-record-commands
9203 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
9204 @sc{nntp} server (along with a timestep) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
9205 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@sc{nntp} connection
9206 that doesn't seem to work.
9212 @subsection News Spool
9216 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
9217 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
9218 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
9221 Anyways, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
9222 anything else) as the address.
9224 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
9225 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
9226 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
9227 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
9231 @item nnspool-inews-program
9232 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
9233 Program used to post an article.
9235 @item nnspool-inews-switches
9236 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
9237 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
9239 @item nnspool-spool-directory
9240 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
9241 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
9242 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
9244 @item nnspool-nov-directory
9245 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
9246 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @sc{nov} files. This is normally
9247 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
9249 @item nnspool-lib-dir
9250 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
9251 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
9253 @item nnspool-active-file
9254 @vindex nnspool-active-file
9255 The path to the active file.
9257 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
9258 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
9259 The path to the group descriptions file.
9261 @item nnspool-history-file
9262 @vindex nnspool-history-file
9263 The path to the news history file.
9265 @item nnspool-active-times-file
9266 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
9267 The path to the active date file.
9269 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
9270 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
9271 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @sc{nov} files
9274 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
9275 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
9277 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
9278 relevant portion from the overview file. If nil, @code{nnspool} will
9279 load the entire file into a buffer and process it there.
9285 @section Getting Mail
9286 @cindex reading mail
9289 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
9293 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
9294 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
9295 * Mail Backend Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
9296 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
9297 * Mail and Procmail:: Reading mail groups that procmail create.
9298 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
9299 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
9300 * Washing Mail:: Removing gruft from the mail you get.
9301 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
9302 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail backends for reading other files.
9303 * Choosing a Mail Backend:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
9307 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
9308 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
9310 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
9311 mail backend of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
9312 and things will happen automatically.
9314 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a "one file per
9315 mail" backend), you could put the following in your @file{.gnus} file:
9318 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
9319 '((nnml "private")))
9322 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this backend will be queried for new
9323 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
9324 directory, which is @code{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
9325 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
9326 like any other group.
9328 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
9331 (setq nnmail-split-methods
9332 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
9333 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
9337 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
9338 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
9339 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
9342 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
9343 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
9344 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Backend} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
9347 @node Splitting Mail
9348 @subsection Splitting Mail
9349 @cindex splitting mail
9350 @cindex mail splitting
9352 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
9353 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
9354 to be split into groups.
9357 (setq nnmail-split-methods
9358 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
9359 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
9363 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
9364 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
9365 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
9366 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
9367 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
9368 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
9369 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
9372 ("list.\\1" "From:.*\\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
9375 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
9376 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
9377 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
9378 mail belongs in that group.
9380 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
9381 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{} so that it matches any mails
9382 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
9383 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first
9384 rule to make a match will "win", unless you have crossposting enabled.
9385 In that case, all matching rules will "win".)
9387 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
9388 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
9389 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
9390 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
9391 thinks should carry this mail message.
9393 Note that the mail backends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
9394 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
9395 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
9396 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
9398 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
9399 The mail backends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
9400 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
9401 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
9402 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{}) group.
9404 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
9407 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
9408 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
9409 links. If that's the case for you, set
9410 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
9411 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
9413 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
9414 @kindex nnmail-split-history
9415 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
9416 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command.
9418 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
9419 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
9420 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
9421 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
9422 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
9423 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
9424 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
9425 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
9429 @node Mail Backend Variables
9430 @subsection Mail Backend Variables
9432 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
9436 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
9437 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
9438 The mail backends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
9439 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
9441 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
9442 @item nnmail-spool-file
9446 @vindex nnmail-pop-password
9447 @vindex nnmail-pop-password-required
9448 The backends will look for new mail in this file. If this variable is
9449 @code{nil}, the mail backends will never attempt to fetch mail by
9450 themselves. If you are using a POP mail server and your name is
9451 @samp{larsi}, you should set this variable to @samp{po:larsi}. If
9452 your name is not @samp{larsi}, you should probably modify that
9453 slightly, but you may have guessed that already, you smart & handsome
9454 devil! You can also set this variable to @code{pop}, and Gnus will try
9455 to figure out the POP mail string by itself. In any case, Gnus will
9456 call @code{movemail} which will contact the POP server named in the
9457 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable. If the POP server needs a
9458 password, you can either set @code{nnmail-pop-password-required} to
9459 @code{t} and be prompted for the password, or set
9460 @code{nnmail-pop-password} to the password itself.
9462 @code{nnmail-spool-file} can also be a list of mailboxes.
9464 Your Emacs has to have been configured with @samp{--with-pop} before
9465 compilation. This is the default, but some installations have it
9468 When you use a mail backend, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
9469 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
9470 mail if you're not using a mail backend---you have to do a lot of magic
9471 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
9472 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
9473 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
9475 @vindex nnmail-use-procmail
9476 @vindex nnmail-procmail-suffix
9477 @item nnmail-use-procmail
9478 If non-@code{nil}, the mail backends will look in
9479 @code{nnmail-procmail-directory} for incoming mail. All the files in
9480 that directory that have names ending in @code{nnmail-procmail-suffix}
9481 will be considered incoming mailboxes, and will be searched for new
9484 @vindex nnmail-crash-box
9485 @item nnmail-crash-box
9486 When a mail backend reads a spool file, mail is first moved to this
9487 file, which is @file{~/.gnus-crash-box} by default. If this file
9488 already exists, it will always be read (and incorporated) before any
9491 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
9492 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
9493 This is run in a buffer that holds all the new incoming mail, and can be
9494 used for, well, anything, really.
9496 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
9497 @item nnmail-split-hook
9498 @findex article-decode-rfc1522
9499 @findex RFC1522 decoding
9500 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
9501 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
9502 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
9503 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
9504 in the buffer will show up in any files. @code{gnus-article-decode-rfc1522}
9505 is one likely function to add to this hook.
9507 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
9508 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
9509 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
9510 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
9511 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
9512 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
9513 starting to handle the new mail) and
9514 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
9515 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
9516 default file modes the new mail files get:
9519 (add-hook 'gnus-pre-get-new-mail-hook
9520 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
9522 (add-hook 'gnus-post-get-new-mail-hook
9523 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
9526 @item nnmail-tmp-directory
9527 @vindex nnmail-tmp-directory
9528 This variable says where to move incoming mail to -- while processing
9529 it. This is usually done in the same directory that the mail backend
9530 inhabits (e.g., @file{~/Mail/}), but if this variable is non-@code{nil},
9531 it will be used instead.
9533 @item nnmail-movemail-program
9534 @vindex nnmail-movemail-program
9535 This program is executed to move mail from the user's inbox to her home
9536 directory. The default is @samp{movemail}.
9538 This can also be a function. In that case, the function will be called
9539 with two parameters -- the name of the inbox, and the file to be moved
9542 @item nnmail-delete-incoming
9543 @vindex nnmail-delete-incoming
9544 @cindex incoming mail files
9545 @cindex deleting incoming files
9546 If non-@code{nil}, the mail backends will delete the temporary incoming
9547 file after splitting mail into the proper groups. This is @code{t} by
9550 @c This is @code{nil} by
9551 @c default for reasons of security.
9553 @c Since Red Gnus is an alpha release, it is to be expected to lose mail.
9554 (No Gnus release since (ding) Gnus 0.10 (or something like that) have
9555 lost mail, I think, but that's not the point. (Except certain versions
9556 of Red Gnus.)) By not deleting the Incoming* files, one can be sure not
9557 to lose mail -- if Gnus totally whacks out, one can always recover what
9560 You may delete the @file{Incoming*} files at will.
9562 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
9563 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
9564 If non-@code{nil}, the mail backends will use long file and directory
9565 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
9566 (assuming use of @code{nnml} backend) or files (assuming use of
9567 @code{nnfolder} backend) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
9568 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
9570 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
9571 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
9573 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
9575 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
9576 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
9577 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
9578 the backend (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
9579 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
9584 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
9585 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
9586 @cindex mail splitting
9587 @cindex fancy mail splitting
9589 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
9590 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
9591 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
9592 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
9593 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
9594 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
9596 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
9599 ;; Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of
9600 ;; the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group
9601 ;; from real errors.
9602 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
9604 ;; Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant
9605 ;; groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the
9606 ;; (ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.
9607 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
9608 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
9609 ;; Other mailing lists...
9610 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
9611 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
9613 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
9614 ;; Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.
9618 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a (possibly)
9619 recursive structure where each split may contain other splits. Here are
9620 the five possible split syntaxes:
9625 @samp{group}: If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group
9626 name. Normal regexp match expansion will be done. See below for
9630 @var{(FIELD VALUE SPLIT)}: If the split is a list, the first element of
9631 which is a string, then store the message as specified by SPLIT, if
9632 header FIELD (a regexp) contains VALUE (also a regexp).
9635 @var{(| SPLIT...)}: If the split is a list, and the first element is
9636 @code{|} (vertical bar), then process each SPLIT until one of them
9637 matches. A SPLIT is said to match if it will cause the mail message to
9638 be stored in one or more groups.
9641 @var{(& SPLIT...)}: If the split is a list, and the first element is
9642 @code{&}, then process all SPLITs in the list.
9645 @code{junk}: If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save
9646 this message. Use with extreme caution.
9649 @var{(: function arg1 arg2 ...)}: If the split is a list, and the first
9650 element is @code{:}, then the second element will be called as a
9651 function with @var{args} given as arguments. The function should return
9656 In these splits, @var{FIELD} must match a complete field name.
9657 @var{VALUE} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
9658 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
9659 field names or words. In other words, all @var{VALUE}'s are wrapped in
9660 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
9662 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
9663 @var{FIELD} and @var{VALUE} can also be lisp symbols, in that case they
9664 are expanded as specified by the variable
9665 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells, where
9666 the @code{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @code{cdr} contains the associated
9669 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
9670 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
9671 when all this splitting is performed.
9673 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
9674 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
9675 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
9678 (any "debian-\\(\\w*\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
9681 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
9682 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\1}
9683 up to @samp{\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
9684 groupings 1 through 9.
9687 @node Mail and Procmail
9688 @subsection Mail and Procmail
9693 Many people use @code{procmail} (or some other mail filter program or
9694 external delivery agent---@code{slocal}, @code{elm}, etc) to split
9695 incoming mail into groups. If you do that, you should set
9696 @code{nnmail-spool-file} to @code{procmail} to ensure that the mail
9697 backends never ever try to fetch mail by themselves.
9699 If you have a combined @code{procmail}/POP/mailbox setup, you can do
9700 something like the following:
9702 @vindex nnmail-use-procmail
9704 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
9705 (setq nnmail-spool-file
9706 '("/usr/spool/mail/my-name" "po:my-name"))
9709 This also means that you probably don't want to set
9710 @code{nnmail-split-methods} either, which has some, perhaps, unexpected
9713 When a mail backend is queried for what groups it carries, it replies
9714 with the contents of that variable, along with any groups it has figured
9715 out that it carries by other means. None of the backends, except
9716 @code{nnmh}, actually go out to the disk and check what groups actually
9717 exist. (It's not trivial to distinguish between what the user thinks is
9718 a basis for a newsgroup and what is just a plain old file or directory.)
9720 This means that you have to tell Gnus (and the backends) by hand what
9723 Let's take the @code{nnmh} backend as an example:
9725 The folders are located in @code{nnmh-directory}, say, @file{~/Mail/}.
9726 There are three folders, @file{foo}, @file{bar} and @file{mail.baz}.
9728 Go to the group buffer and type @kbd{G m}. When prompted, answer
9729 @samp{foo} for the name and @samp{nnmh} for the method. Repeat
9730 twice for the two other groups, @samp{bar} and @samp{mail.baz}. Be sure
9731 to include all your mail groups.
9733 That's it. You are now set to read your mail. An active file for this
9734 method will be created automatically.
9736 @vindex nnmail-procmail-suffix
9737 @vindex nnmail-procmail-directory
9738 If you use @code{nnfolder} or any other backend that store more than a
9739 single article in each file, you should never have procmail add mails to
9740 the file that Gnus sees. Instead, procmail should put all incoming mail
9741 in @code{nnmail-procmail-directory}. To arrive at the file name to put
9742 the incoming mail in, append @code{nnmail-procmail-suffix} to the group
9743 name. The mail backends will read the mail from these files.
9745 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
9746 When Gnus reads a file called @file{mail.misc.spool}, this mail will be
9747 put in the @code{mail.misc}, as one would expect. However, if you want
9748 Gnus to split the mail the normal way, you could set
9749 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to @code{t}.
9751 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
9752 If you use @code{procmail} to split things directly into an @code{nnmh}
9753 directory (which you shouldn't do), you should set
9754 @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} to non-@code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
9755 ever expiring the final article (i.e., the article with the highest
9756 article number) in a mail newsgroup. This is quite, quite important.
9758 Here's an example setup: The incoming spools are located in
9759 @file{~/incoming/} and have @samp{""} as suffixes (i.e., the incoming
9760 spool files have the same names as the equivalent groups). The
9761 @code{nnfolder} backend is to be used as the mail interface, and the
9762 @code{nnfolder} directory is @file{~/fMail/}.
9765 (setq nnfolder-directory "~/fMail/")
9766 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
9767 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/incoming/")
9768 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnfolder "")))
9769 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "")
9773 @node Incorporating Old Mail
9774 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
9776 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
9777 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
9778 backends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
9781 Doing so can be quite easy.
9783 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
9784 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
9785 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
9786 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
9787 your @code{nnml} groups.
9793 Go to the group buffer.
9796 Type `G f' and give the path to the mbox file when prompted to create an
9797 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
9800 Type `SPACE' to enter the newly created group.
9803 Type `M P b' to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
9804 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
9807 Type `B r' to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
9808 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
9811 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
9812 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
9813 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
9814 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
9815 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
9817 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
9818 backend to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
9819 using the new mail backend.
9823 @subsection Expiring Mail
9824 @cindex article expiry
9826 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
9827 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
9828 different approach to mail reading.
9830 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
9831 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
9832 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
9833 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
9834 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
9835 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
9838 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
9839 articles as @dfn{expirable}. This does not mean that the articles will
9840 disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
9841 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
9842 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
9843 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
9844 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
9845 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
9847 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
9848 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Groups that
9849 match the regular expression @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will
9850 have all articles that you read marked as expirable automatically. All
9851 articles marked as expirable have an @samp{E} in the first
9852 column in the summary buffer.
9854 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
9855 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
9856 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
9857 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
9860 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
9862 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
9863 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
9864 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
9867 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
9868 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
9869 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
9870 groups expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
9871 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
9873 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
9874 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
9877 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
9878 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
9881 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
9882 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
9884 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
9885 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
9886 don't really mix very well.
9888 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
9889 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
9890 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
9891 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
9894 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
9895 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
9896 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
9897 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
9900 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
9902 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
9904 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
9906 ((string= group "mail.junk")
9908 ((string= group "important")
9914 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
9915 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
9917 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
9918 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
9919 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
9922 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
9923 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9925 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
9926 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
9927 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
9928 easier for procmail users.
9930 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
9931 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
9932 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
9933 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
9934 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
9935 caution. Even more dangerous is the
9936 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
9937 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
9938 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
9939 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
9940 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
9941 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
9942 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
9945 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
9949 @subsection Washing Mail
9950 @cindex mail washing
9951 @cindex list server brain damage
9952 @cindex incoming mail treatment
9954 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
9955 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC822 doesn't explicitly
9956 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
9957 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
9958 Yes, but RFC822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
9959 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
9961 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
9962 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
9963 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
9966 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
9967 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
9968 storing the mail to disc. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
9969 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
9972 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
9973 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
9974 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
9975 grand, sweeping gestures. Functions to be used include:
9978 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
9979 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
9980 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
9981 Emacs running on MS machines.
9985 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
9986 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
9987 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
9988 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
9991 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
9992 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
9993 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
9994 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
9996 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
9997 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
9998 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
9999 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
10000 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
10001 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
10002 also be a list of regexp.
10004 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
10005 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
10008 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
10009 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
10012 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
10013 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
10014 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
10018 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
10019 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
10020 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
10024 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
10025 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
10026 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
10033 @subsection Duplicates
10035 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
10036 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
10037 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
10038 @cindex duplicate mails
10039 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
10040 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
10041 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
10042 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
10043 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
10044 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
10045 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
10046 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
10047 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
10048 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
10049 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
10050 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
10051 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
10053 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
10054 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
10055 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
10056 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
10058 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
10061 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
10062 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
10066 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
10067 '(| ;; Messages duplicates go to a separate group.
10068 ("gnus-warning" "duplication of message" "duplicate")
10069 ;; Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.
10070 (any mail "mail.misc")
10077 (setq nnmail-split-methods
10078 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:")
10083 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
10084 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
10085 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
10086 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
10087 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
10090 @node Not Reading Mail
10091 @subsection Not Reading Mail
10093 If you start using any of the mail backends, they have the annoying
10094 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
10095 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
10097 If you set @code{nnmail-spool-file} to @code{nil}, none of the backends
10098 will ever attempt to read incoming mail, which should help.
10100 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
10101 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
10102 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
10103 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
10104 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
10105 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
10106 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old @sc{rmail}
10107 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All backends have
10108 variables called backend-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
10109 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
10110 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
10112 All the mail backends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
10113 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
10117 @node Choosing a Mail Backend
10118 @subsection Choosing a Mail Backend
10120 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
10121 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
10122 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
10125 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
10126 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
10127 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
10128 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like backend.
10129 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
10133 @node Unix Mail Box
10134 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
10136 @cindex unix mail box
10138 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
10139 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
10140 The @dfn{nnmbox} backend will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
10141 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
10142 which group it belongs in.
10144 Virtual server settings:
10147 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
10148 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
10149 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory.
10151 @item nnmbox-active-file
10152 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
10153 The name of the active file for the mail box.
10155 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
10156 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
10157 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
10163 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
10167 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
10168 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
10169 The @dfn{nnbabyl} backend will use a babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{rmail
10170 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail
10171 article to say which group it belongs in.
10173 Virtual server settings:
10176 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
10177 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
10178 The name of the rmail mbox file.
10180 @item nnbabyl-active-file
10181 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
10182 The name of the active file for the rmail box.
10184 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
10185 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
10186 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail.
10191 @subsubsection Mail Spool
10193 @cindex mail @sc{nov} spool
10195 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
10196 format. It should be used with some caution.
10198 @vindex nnml-directory
10199 If you use this backend, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
10200 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
10201 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
10202 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
10204 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
10207 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
10208 in your account, you should not use this backend. As each mail gets its
10209 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
10210 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
10211 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
10212 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
10213 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
10214 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
10216 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest backend when it comes to article
10217 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
10218 @sc{nov} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it the fastest
10219 backend when it comes to reading mail.
10221 Virtual server settings:
10224 @item nnml-directory
10225 @vindex nnml-directory
10226 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory.
10228 @item nnml-active-file
10229 @vindex nnml-active-file
10230 The active file for the @code{nnml} server.
10232 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
10233 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
10234 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
10237 @item nnml-get-new-mail
10238 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
10239 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail.
10241 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
10242 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
10243 If non-@code{nil}, this backend will ignore any @sc{nov} files.
10245 @item nnml-nov-file-name
10246 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
10247 The name of the @sc{nov} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
10249 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
10250 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
10251 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
10255 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
10256 If your @code{nnml} groups and @sc{nov} files get totally out of whack,
10257 you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
10258 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
10259 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
10260 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
10261 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
10266 @subsubsection MH Spool
10268 @cindex mh-e mail spool
10270 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
10271 @sc{nov} databases and it doesn't keep an active file. This makes
10272 @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower backend than @code{nnml}, but it also
10273 makes it easier to write procmail scripts for.
10275 Virtual server settings:
10278 @item nnmh-directory
10279 @vindex nnmh-directory
10280 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory.
10282 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
10283 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
10284 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail.
10287 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
10288 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
10289 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks they
10290 are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
10291 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
10292 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not have
10293 to set this variable to @code{t}.
10298 @subsubsection Mail Folders
10300 @cindex mbox folders
10301 @cindex mail folders
10303 @code{nnfolder} is a backend for storing each mail group in a separate
10304 file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format. @code{nnfolder}
10305 will add extra headers to keep track of article numbers and arrival
10308 Virtual server settings:
10311 @item nnfolder-directory
10312 @vindex nnfolder-directory
10313 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this directory.
10315 @item nnfolder-active-file
10316 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
10317 The name of the active file.
10319 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
10320 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
10321 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File Format}.
10323 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
10324 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
10325 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail.
10328 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
10329 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
10330 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
10331 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
10332 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
10333 @code{nnfolder-directory}.
10336 @node Other Sources
10337 @section Other Sources
10339 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
10340 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
10344 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
10345 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
10346 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
10347 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{SOUP} packets ``offline''.
10348 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
10349 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
10353 @node Directory Groups
10354 @subsection Directory Groups
10356 @cindex directory groups
10358 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
10359 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
10362 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
10363 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
10364 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
10365 backend to read directories. Big deal.
10367 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
10368 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
10369 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
10370 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
10371 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
10373 @code{nndir} will use @sc{nov} files if they are present.
10375 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' backend---you can't delete or expire
10376 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
10377 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
10378 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
10381 @node Anything Groups
10382 @subsection Anything Groups
10385 From the @code{nndir} backend (which reads a single spool-like
10386 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
10387 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
10390 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
10391 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
10392 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
10393 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're
10394 forgetting. @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it
10395 snoops each file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e.,
10396 the first few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head.
10397 If this is just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source
10398 file), @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It
10399 will use file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
10402 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
10403 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
10404 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
10405 in the article buffer, just as usual.
10407 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
10408 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
10409 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
10410 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
10412 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
10413 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
10414 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
10415 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
10416 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
10417 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
10418 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
10419 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
10424 @item nneething-map-file-directory
10425 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
10426 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
10427 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
10429 @item nneething-exclude-files
10430 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
10431 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
10432 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
10434 @item nneething-map-file
10435 @vindex nneething-map-file
10436 Name of the map files.
10440 @node Document Groups
10441 @subsection Document Groups
10443 @cindex documentation group
10446 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
10447 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
10454 The babyl (rmail) mail box.
10459 The standard Unix mbox file.
10461 @cindex MMDF mail box
10463 The MMDF mail box format.
10466 Several news articles appended into a file.
10469 @cindex rnews batch files
10470 The rnews batch transport format.
10471 @cindex forwarded messages
10474 Forwarded articles.
10478 @cindex MIME digest
10479 @cindex 1153 digest
10480 @cindex RFC 1153 digest
10481 @cindex RFC 341 digest
10482 MIME (RFC 1341) digest format.
10484 @item standard-digest
10485 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
10488 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
10491 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
10492 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
10493 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
10496 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
10497 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
10498 group. And that's it.
10500 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
10501 new & spiffy Gnus mail backend, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
10502 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
10503 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
10504 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
10505 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
10506 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
10507 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
10508 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
10509 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
10511 Virtual server variables:
10514 @item nndoc-article-type
10515 @vindex nndoc-article-type
10516 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
10517 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
10518 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-digest}, @code{standard-digest},
10519 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs} or @code{guess}.
10521 @item nndoc-post-type
10522 @vindex nndoc-post-type
10523 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
10524 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
10529 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
10533 @node Document Server Internals
10534 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
10536 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
10537 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
10538 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
10539 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
10541 First, here's an example document type definition:
10545 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
10546 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
10549 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
10550 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
10551 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
10552 types can be defined with very few settings:
10555 @item first-article
10556 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
10557 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
10560 @item article-begin
10561 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
10562 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
10564 @item head-begin-function
10565 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
10568 @item nndoc-head-begin
10569 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
10572 @item nndoc-head-end
10573 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
10574 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
10576 @item body-begin-function
10577 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
10581 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
10584 @item body-end-function
10585 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
10589 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
10592 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
10593 regexp will be totally ignored.
10597 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
10598 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
10599 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
10600 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
10601 something that's palatable for Gnus:
10604 @item prepare-body-function
10605 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
10606 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
10607 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
10609 @item article-transform-function
10610 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
10611 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
10612 body of the article.
10614 @item generate-head-function
10615 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
10616 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
10617 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
10618 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
10622 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
10627 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
10628 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
10629 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
10630 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
10631 (head-end . "^ ?$")
10632 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
10633 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
10634 (subtype digest guess))
10637 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
10638 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
10639 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
10640 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
10641 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
10643 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
10644 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first is
10645 the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says where in
10646 the document type definition alist to put this definition. The alist is
10647 traversed sequentially, and @code{nndoc-TYPE-type-p} is called for a given type @code{TYPE}. So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document
10648 is of @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
10649 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it is
10650 of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
10651 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number means
10652 low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
10660 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
10661 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
10662 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
10664 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
10665 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
10666 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
10669 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something a that's a bit
10670 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
10671 that interested in doing things properly.
10673 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
10674 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
10677 First some terminology:
10682 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
10683 get news and/or mail from.
10686 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
10687 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
10690 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
10694 @item message packets
10695 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
10696 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
10697 default, where @var{X} is a number.
10699 @item response packets
10700 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
10701 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
10702 default, where @var{X} is a number.
10712 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
10713 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
10714 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
10715 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
10718 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
10721 You put the packet in your home directory.
10724 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} backend as
10725 the native or secondary server.
10728 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
10729 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
10732 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
10736 You transfer this packet to the server.
10739 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
10742 You then repeat until you die.
10746 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
10747 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
10750 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
10751 * SOUP Groups:: A backend for reading @sc{soup} packets.
10752 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
10756 @node SOUP Commands
10757 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
10759 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
10763 @kindex G s b (Group)
10764 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
10765 Pack all unread articles in the current group
10766 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
10767 process/prefix convention.
10770 @kindex G s w (Group)
10771 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
10772 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
10775 @kindex G s s (Group)
10776 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
10777 Send all replies from the replies packet
10778 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
10781 @kindex G s p (Group)
10782 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
10783 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
10786 @kindex G s r (Group)
10787 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
10788 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
10791 @kindex O s (Summary)
10792 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
10793 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
10794 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
10795 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10800 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
10805 @item gnus-soup-directory
10806 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
10807 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
10808 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
10810 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
10811 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
10812 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
10813 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
10815 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
10816 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
10817 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
10818 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
10820 @item gnus-soup-packer
10821 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
10822 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
10823 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
10825 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
10826 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
10827 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
10828 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
10830 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
10831 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
10832 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
10834 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
10835 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
10836 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
10837 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
10843 @subsubsection @sc{soup} Groups
10846 @code{nnsoup} is the backend for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
10847 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
10848 you can read them at leisure.
10850 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
10854 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
10855 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
10856 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
10857 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
10859 @item nnsoup-directory
10860 @vindex nnsoup-directory
10861 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
10862 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
10864 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
10865 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
10866 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
10867 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/"}.
10869 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
10870 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
10871 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
10872 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
10873 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
10875 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
10876 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
10877 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
10878 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
10880 @item nnsoup-active-file
10881 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
10882 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
10883 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
10884 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
10885 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
10887 @item nnsoup-packer
10888 @vindex nnsoup-packer
10889 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
10890 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
10892 @item nnsoup-unpacker
10893 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
10894 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
10895 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
10897 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
10898 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
10899 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
10902 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
10903 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
10904 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
10907 @item nnsoup-always-save
10908 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
10909 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
10915 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
10917 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
10918 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
10919 more for that to happen.
10921 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
10922 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
10923 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
10926 In specific, this is what it does:
10929 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
10930 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
10933 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
10934 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
10935 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
10939 @subsection Web Searches
10943 @cindex InReference
10944 @cindex Usenet searches
10945 @cindex searching the Usenet
10947 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
10948 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
10949 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
10950 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
10951 searches without having to use a browser.
10953 The @code{nnweb} backend allows an easy interface to the mighty search
10954 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
10955 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
10956 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
10957 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
10959 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
10960 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
10961 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
10962 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
10963 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
10964 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
10965 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
10966 engines (DejaNews, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
10967 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
10968 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
10971 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
10972 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
10973 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'
\e$BsU
\e(Bre} is to
10974 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
10975 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
10976 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
10978 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
10979 to use @code{nnweb}.
10981 Virtual server variables:
10986 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
10987 are @code{dejanews}, @code{dejanewsold}, @code{altavista} and
10991 @vindex nnweb-search
10992 The search string to feed to the search engine.
10994 @item nnweb-max-hits
10995 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
10996 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
10999 @item nnweb-type-definition
11000 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
11001 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
11002 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
11007 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
11011 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
11014 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
11017 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
11021 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
11028 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
11029 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
11030 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
11033 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
11034 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
11035 The @code{nngateway} backend provides the interface.
11037 Note that you can't read anything from this backend---it can only be
11043 @item nngateway-address
11044 @vindex nngateway-address
11045 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
11047 @item nngateway-header-transformation
11048 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
11049 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
11050 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
11051 transformation should be called, and defaults to
11052 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
11053 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
11056 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
11057 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
11058 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
11061 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
11064 will get this @code{From} header inserted:
11067 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
11070 The following pre-defined functions exist:
11072 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
11075 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
11076 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
11077 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
11079 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
11081 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
11082 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
11083 @code{nngateway-address}.
11088 (setq gnus-post-method
11089 '(nngateway "mail2news@@replay.com"
11090 (nngateway-header-transformation
11091 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
11099 So, to use this, simply say something like:
11102 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
11106 @node Combined Groups
11107 @section Combined Groups
11109 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
11113 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
11114 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
11118 @node Virtual Groups
11119 @subsection Virtual Groups
11121 @cindex virtual groups
11122 @cindex merging groups
11124 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
11127 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
11128 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
11129 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
11131 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
11132 regexp to match component groups.
11134 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
11135 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
11136 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it came.
11137 (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be shown in
11138 the virtual group.)
11140 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
11141 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
11144 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
11147 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
11148 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
11150 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
11151 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
11152 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
11153 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
11156 "^nntp\\+some\\.server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+some\\.server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
11159 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
11160 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
11161 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
11163 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
11164 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
11165 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
11166 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
11167 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
11169 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
11170 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
11171 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
11173 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
11174 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
11175 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
11176 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
11177 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
11178 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
11179 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
11180 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
11181 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
11182 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
11183 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
11186 @node Kibozed Groups
11187 @subsection Kibozed Groups
11191 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by @sc{oed} as ``grepping through (parts of)
11192 the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a backend that will do this for
11193 you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @sc{nntp} server down to a halt
11194 with useless requests! Oh happiness!
11196 @kindex G k (Group)
11197 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
11200 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
11201 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
11202 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between @code{nnkiboze}
11203 and @code{nnvirtual} end.
11205 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an @code{nnkiboze} group
11206 must have a score file to say what articles are to be included in
11207 the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
11209 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
11210 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
11211 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
11212 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time. Lots of
11213 time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the headers from
11214 all the articles in all the component groups and run them through the
11215 scoring process to determine if there are any articles in the groups
11216 that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
11218 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
11219 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
11220 @sc{nntp} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
11221 Stranger things have happened.
11223 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
11224 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
11226 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
11227 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
11228 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/} by default. One
11229 contains the @sc{nov} header lines for all the articles in the group,
11230 and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store information
11231 on what groups have been searched through to find component articles.
11233 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
11234 their @sc{nov} lines removed from the @sc{nov} file.
11237 @node Gnus Unplugged
11238 @section Gnus Unplugged
11243 @cindex Gnus Unplugged
11245 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
11246 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
11247 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
11248 read news. Believe it or not.
11250 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
11251 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
11252 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
11253 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
11254 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
11256 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
11257 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
11258 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
11259 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
11260 reading news on a machine.
11262 Using Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple.
11266 First, set up Gnus as you would do if you were running it on a machine
11267 that has full connection to the net. Go ahead. I'll still be waiting
11271 Then, put the following magical incantation at the end of your
11272 @file{.gnus.el} file:
11279 That's it. Gnus is now an ``offline'' newsreader.
11281 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
11284 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
11285 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
11286 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
11287 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
11288 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
11289 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
11290 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
11291 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
11296 @subsection Agent Basics
11298 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
11300 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
11301 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
11302 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
11303 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
11305 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
11306 connected to the net continuously.
11308 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
11309 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
11311 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
11316 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
11317 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
11318 already fetched while in this mode.
11321 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
11322 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
11323 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged}.
11326 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the news
11327 onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press @kbd{J
11328 s} to fetch all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus
11329 know which articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}.)
11332 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
11333 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
11334 then you read the news offline.
11337 And then you go to step 2.
11340 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
11346 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
11347 backend, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
11348 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
11349 @kbd{J a} the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
11350 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}). This will typically be only the
11351 primary select method, which is listed on the bottom in the buffer.
11354 Decide on download policy. @xref{Agent Categories}
11361 @node Agent Categories
11362 @subsection Agent Categories
11364 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
11365 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
11366 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
11367 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
11368 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
11369 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
11370 you're interested in the articles anyway.
11372 The main way to control what is to be downloaded is to create a
11373 @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all) groups to this category.
11374 Gnus has its own buffer for creating and managing categories.
11377 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
11378 * The Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
11379 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
11383 @node Category Syntax
11384 @subsubsection Category Syntax
11386 A category consists of two things.
11390 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
11391 are eligible for downloading; and
11394 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
11395 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
11396 score} is wholly unrelated to normal scores.)
11399 A predicate consists of predicates with logical operators sprinkled in
11402 Perhaps some examples are in order.
11404 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
11405 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
11411 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
11412 short (for some value of ``short'').
11414 Here's a more complex predicate:
11423 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
11424 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
11427 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
11428 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
11429 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
11431 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
11432 you want to do, you can write your own.
11436 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
11437 lines; default 100.
11440 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
11441 lines; default 200.
11444 True iff the article has a download score less than
11445 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
11448 True iff the article has a download score greater than
11449 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
11452 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
11453 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
11454 checksum and sees whether articles match.
11463 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
11464 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
11465 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
11468 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
11469 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
11470 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
11471 following headers can be scored on: @code{From}, @code{Subject},
11472 @code{Date}, @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars}, @code{Message-ID},
11473 and @code{References}.
11476 @node The Category Buffer
11477 @subsubsection The Category Buffer
11479 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
11480 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
11481 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
11483 The following commands are available in this buffer:
11487 @kindex q (Category)
11488 @findex gnus-category-exit
11489 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
11492 @kindex k (Category)
11493 @findex gnus-category-kill
11494 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
11497 @kindex c (Category)
11498 @findex gnus-category-copy
11499 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
11502 @kindex a (Category)
11503 @findex gnus-category-add
11504 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
11507 @kindex p (Category)
11508 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
11509 Edit the predicate of the current category
11510 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
11513 @kindex g (Category)
11514 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
11515 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
11516 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
11519 @kindex s (Category)
11520 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
11521 Edit the download score rule of the current category
11522 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
11525 @kindex l (Category)
11526 @findex gnus-category-list
11527 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
11531 @node Category Variables
11532 @subsubsection Category Variables
11535 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
11536 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
11537 Hook run in category buffers.
11539 @item gnus-category-line-format
11540 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
11541 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
11542 Variables}). Valid elements are:
11546 The name of the category.
11549 The number of groups in the category.
11552 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
11553 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
11554 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
11556 @item gnus-agent-short-article
11557 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
11558 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
11560 @item gnus-agent-long-article
11561 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
11562 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
11564 @item gnus-agent-low-score
11565 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
11566 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
11569 @item gnus-agent-high-score
11570 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
11571 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
11577 @node Agent Commands
11578 @subsection Agent Commands
11580 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
11581 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged} command works in all modes, and
11582 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
11586 * Group Agent Commands::
11587 * Summary Agent Commands::
11588 * Server Agent Commands::
11591 You can run a complete batch fetch from the command line with the
11592 following incantation:
11594 @cindex gnus-agent-batch-fetch
11596 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch-fetch
11601 @node Group Agent Commands
11602 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
11606 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
11607 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
11608 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
11609 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
11612 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
11613 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
11614 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
11617 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
11618 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
11619 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
11620 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
11623 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
11624 @findex gnus-group-send-drafts
11625 Send all sendable messages in the draft group
11626 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}). @xref{Drafts}
11629 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
11630 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
11631 Add the current group to an Agent category
11632 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}).
11637 @node Summary Agent Commands
11638 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
11642 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
11643 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
11644 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
11647 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
11648 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
11649 Remove the downloading mark from the article
11650 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
11653 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
11654 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
11655 Toggle whether to download the article (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}).
11658 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
11659 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
11660 Mark all undownloaded articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}).
11665 @node Server Agent Commands
11666 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
11670 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
11671 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
11672 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
11673 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
11676 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
11677 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
11678 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
11679 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
11685 @subsection Agent Expiry
11687 @vindex gnus-agent-expiry-days
11688 @findex gnus-agent-expiry
11689 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expiry
11690 @cindex Agent expiry
11691 @cindex Gnus Agent expiry
11694 @code{nnagent} doesn't handle expiry. Instead, there's a special
11695 @code{gnus-agent-expiry} command that will expire all read articles that
11696 are older than @code{gnus-agent-expiry-days} days. It can be run
11697 whenever you feel that you're running out of space. It's not
11698 particularly fast or efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to
11699 interrupt it (with @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started it.
11701 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
11702 if @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, this command will
11703 expire all articles---unread, read, ticked and dormant. If @code{nil}
11704 (which is the default), only read articles are eligible for expiry, and
11705 unread, ticked and dormant articles will be kept indefinitely.
11708 @node Outgoing Messages
11709 @subsection Outgoing Messages
11711 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
11712 stored in the draft groups (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view them there
11713 after posting, and edit them at will.
11715 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
11716 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
11717 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
11718 messages in the draft group.
11722 @node Agent Variables
11723 @subsection Agent Variables
11726 @item gnus-agent-directory
11727 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
11728 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
11729 @file{~/News/agent/}.
11731 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
11732 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
11733 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
11734 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
11735 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
11738 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
11739 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
11740 Hook run when connecting to the network.
11742 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
11743 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
11744 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
11749 @node Example Setup
11750 @subsection Example Setup
11752 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
11753 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
11754 @file{.gnus.el} file to get started.
11757 ;;; Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over NNTP
11758 ;;; from your ISP's server.
11759 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "nntp.your-isp.com"))
11761 ;;; Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from
11762 ;;; your ISP's POP server.
11763 (setenv "MAILHOST" "pop.your-isp.com")
11764 (setq nnmail-spool-file "po:username")
11766 ;;; Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.
11767 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
11769 ;;; Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.
11773 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
11774 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
11777 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
11778 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
11779 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
11780 @sc{nntp} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
11781 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
11784 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
11785 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
11786 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
11787 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
11788 back all the killed groups.)
11790 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
11791 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
11792 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
11795 @node Batching Agents
11796 @subsection Batching Agents
11798 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
11799 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
11800 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
11804 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null
11813 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
11814 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
11815 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
11818 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
11819 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
11820 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
11821 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
11822 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
11824 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
11825 before generating the summary buffer.
11827 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
11828 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
11829 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
11831 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
11832 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
11833 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
11834 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
11837 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
11838 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
11839 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
11840 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
11841 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
11842 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
11843 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
11844 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
11845 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
11846 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
11847 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
11848 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
11849 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
11850 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
11851 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
11852 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
11856 @node Summary Score Commands
11857 @section Summary Score Commands
11858 @cindex score commands
11860 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
11861 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
11862 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
11863 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
11864 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
11866 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
11867 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
11868 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
11869 score file the current one.
11871 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
11876 @kindex V s (Summary)
11877 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
11878 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
11881 @kindex V S (Summary)
11882 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
11883 Display the score of the current article
11884 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
11887 @kindex V t (Summary)
11888 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
11889 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
11890 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}).
11893 @kindex V R (Summary)
11894 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
11895 Run the current summary through the scoring process
11896 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
11897 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
11898 effect you're having.
11901 @kindex V c (Summary)
11902 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
11903 Make a different score file the current
11904 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
11907 @kindex V e (Summary)
11908 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
11909 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
11910 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
11914 @kindex V f (Summary)
11915 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
11916 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
11917 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
11920 @kindex V F (Summary)
11921 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
11922 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
11923 after editing score files.
11926 @kindex V C (Summary)
11927 @findex gnus-score-customize
11928 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
11929 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
11933 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
11938 @kindex V m (Summary)
11939 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
11940 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
11941 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
11944 @kindex V x (Summary)
11945 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
11946 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
11947 expunge all articles below this score
11948 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
11951 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
11952 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
11955 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
11956 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
11960 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
11961 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
11963 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
11964 keys are available:
11968 Score on the author name.
11971 Score on the subject line.
11974 Score on the Xref line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
11977 Score on thread---the References line.
11983 Score on the number of lines.
11986 Score on the Message-ID.
11989 Score on followups.
11999 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
12000 what headers you are scoring on.
12012 Substring matching.
12015 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
12044 Greater than number.
12049 The fourth and final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e., expiring)
12050 score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry, or whether
12051 it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score file.
12055 Temporary score entry.
12058 Permanent score entry.
12061 Immediately scoring.
12066 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
12067 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
12068 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
12069 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
12071 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
12072 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
12073 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
12074 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
12075 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
12077 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
12078 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
12079 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
12080 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
12081 current score file.
12083 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
12084 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
12085 pretend they are keymaps or not.
12088 @node Group Score Commands
12089 @section Group Score Commands
12090 @cindex group score commands
12092 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
12097 @kindex W f (Group)
12098 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
12099 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
12100 all the time. This command will flush the cache
12101 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
12105 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
12107 @findex gnus-batch-score
12108 @cindex batch scoring
12110 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l gnus -f gnus-batch-score
12114 @node Score Variables
12115 @section Score Variables
12116 @cindex score variables
12120 @item gnus-use-scoring
12121 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
12122 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
12123 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
12125 @item gnus-kill-killed
12126 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
12127 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
12128 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
12129 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
12130 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
12131 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
12132 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
12134 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
12135 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
12136 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
12137 initialized from the @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
12138 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
12140 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
12141 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
12142 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
12143 (@samp{SCORE} by default.)
12145 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
12146 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
12147 @cindex score cache
12148 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
12149 score files. However, if this might make you Emacs grow big and
12150 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
12151 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
12152 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
12153 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
12156 @item gnus-save-score
12157 @vindex gnus-save-score
12158 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
12159 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
12160 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
12162 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
12163 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
12164 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
12165 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
12166 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
12167 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
12168 manually entered data.
12170 @item gnus-summary-default-score
12171 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
12172 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
12174 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
12175 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
12176 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
12177 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
12178 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
12179 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
12181 @item gnus-score-over-mark
12182 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
12183 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
12184 default. Default is @samp{+}.
12186 @item gnus-score-below-mark
12187 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
12188 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
12189 default. Default is @samp{-}.
12191 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
12192 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
12193 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
12194 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
12196 Predefined functions available are:
12199 @item gnus-score-find-single
12200 @findex gnus-score-find-single
12201 Only apply the group's own score file.
12203 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
12204 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
12205 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
12206 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
12207 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
12208 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
12209 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
12210 then a regexp match is done.
12212 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
12213 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
12215 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
12216 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
12217 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
12218 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
12220 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
12221 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
12222 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
12223 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
12224 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE}.
12227 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all these
12228 functions will be called, and all the returned lists of score files will
12229 be applied. These functions can also return lists of score alists
12230 directly. In that case, the functions that return these non-file score
12231 alists should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file
12232 functions, to ensure that the last score file returned is the local
12235 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
12236 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
12237 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
12238 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
12239 are expired. It's 7 by default.
12241 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
12242 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
12243 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, matching score entries will have
12244 their dates updated. (This is how Gnus controls expiry---all
12245 non-matching entries will become too old while matching entries will
12246 stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this variable to @code{nil},
12247 even matching entries will grow old and will have to face that oh-so
12250 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
12251 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
12252 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
12254 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
12255 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
12256 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be simplified
12257 for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
12258 threading---according to the current value of
12259 gnus-simplify-subject-functions. If the scoring entry uses
12260 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
12261 simplified in this manner.
12266 @node Score File Format
12267 @section Score File Format
12268 @cindex score file format
12270 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
12271 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
12272 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
12274 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
12278 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
12280 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
12282 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
12284 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
12289 (mark-and-expunge -10)
12293 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
12294 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
12295 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
12296 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
12300 This example demonstrates most score file elements. For a different
12301 approach, see @pxref{Advanced Scoring}.
12303 Even though this looks much like lisp code, nothing here is actually
12304 @code{eval}ed. The lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
12305 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
12307 Six keys are supported by this alist:
12312 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
12313 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
12314 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
12315 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
12316 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
12317 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
12318 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
12319 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
12320 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
12321 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
12322 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
12323 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
12324 to articles that matches these score entries.
12326 Following this key is a arbitrary number of score entries, where each
12327 score entry has one to four elements.
12331 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
12332 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
12336 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
12337 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
12338 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
12339 is successful. If this element is not present, the
12340 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
12341 instead. This is 1000 by default.
12344 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
12345 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
12346 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
12347 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
12348 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
12351 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
12352 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
12353 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
12354 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
12357 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
12358 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
12359 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
12360 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
12361 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
12362 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
12363 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
12364 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
12365 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
12366 instead, if you feel like.
12369 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
12370 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
12372 These predicates are true if
12375 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
12378 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
12379 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
12386 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
12387 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
12388 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
12389 it's not. I think.)
12391 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some backends (like
12392 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
12393 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
12394 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
12397 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
12398 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
12399 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
12400 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
12401 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
12402 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
12403 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
12407 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
12408 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
12409 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
12410 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
12411 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
12412 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
12413 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
12414 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
12417 @item Head, Body, All
12418 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
12422 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
12423 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
12424 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
12425 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
12426 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
12427 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
12428 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
12432 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
12433 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{X}, then you add a
12434 @samp{thread} match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each
12435 article that has @var{X} in its @code{References} header. (These new
12436 @samp{thread} matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching
12437 articles.) This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an
12438 entire thread, even though some articles in the thread may not have
12439 complete @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
12440 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
12441 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
12445 @cindex Score File Atoms
12447 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
12448 lower than this number will be marked as read.
12451 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
12452 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
12454 @item mark-and-expunge
12455 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
12456 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
12459 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
12460 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
12461 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
12462 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
12463 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
12466 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
12467 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
12470 @item exclude-files
12471 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
12472 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
12476 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
12477 ignored when handling global score files.
12480 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
12481 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
12482 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
12483 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
12486 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
12487 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
12488 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
12489 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
12491 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
12495 (mark-and-expunge -100)
12498 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
12499 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
12500 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
12501 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
12502 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
12504 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where there
12505 exist a few interesting threads which can't be found automatically by
12506 ordinary scoring rules.
12509 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
12510 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
12511 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
12512 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
12513 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
12514 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
12515 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
12516 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
12517 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
12518 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
12519 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
12523 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
12524 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
12525 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
12526 file for a number of groups.
12529 @cindex local variables
12530 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(VAR VALUE)} pairs.
12531 Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the current summary buffer,
12532 and set to the value specified. This is a convenient, if somewhat
12533 strange, way of setting variables in some groups if you don't like hooks
12534 much. Note that the @var{value} won't be evaluated.
12538 @node Score File Editing
12539 @section Score File Editing
12541 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
12542 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
12543 with a mode for that.
12545 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
12546 additional commands:
12551 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
12552 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
12553 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
12554 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
12557 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
12558 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
12559 Insert the current date in numerical format
12560 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
12561 you were wondering.
12564 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
12565 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
12566 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
12567 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
12568 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
12573 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
12575 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
12576 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
12578 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f} and @kbd{V
12579 e} to begin editing score files.
12582 @node Adaptive Scoring
12583 @section Adaptive Scoring
12584 @cindex adaptive scoring
12586 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
12587 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
12588 stupidity, to be precise.
12590 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
12591 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
12592 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
12593 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
12594 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
12595 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
12596 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
12597 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
12598 variable to @code{(word line)}.
12600 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
12601 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
12602 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
12603 might look something like this:
12606 (defvar gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
12607 '((gnus-unread-mark)
12608 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
12609 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
12610 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
12611 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
12612 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
12613 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
12614 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
12615 (gnus-ancient-mark)
12616 (gnus-low-score-mark)
12617 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
12620 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
12621 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
12622 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
12623 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
12624 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
12625 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
12628 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
12629 will be applied to each article.
12631 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
12632 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{D}) will have a
12633 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
12634 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
12636 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
12637 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
12638 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
12639 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
12641 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
12642 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
12643 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
12644 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
12646 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
12647 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
12648 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
12649 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
12650 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
12651 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
12653 You can also score on @code{thread}, which will try to score all
12654 articles that appear in a thread. @code{thread} matches uses a
12655 @code{Message-ID} to match on the @code{References} header of the
12656 article. If the match is made, the @code{Message-ID} of the article is
12657 added to the @code{thread} rule. (Think about it. I'd recommend two
12658 aspirins afterwards.)
12660 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
12661 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
12662 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
12664 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
12665 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
12666 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
12668 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
12669 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
12670 let you use different rules in different groups.
12672 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
12673 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
12674 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
12677 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
12678 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
12679 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
12680 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
12681 the length of the match is less than
12682 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
12683 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
12686 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
12687 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
12688 headers. If you adapt on words, the
12689 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
12690 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
12693 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
12694 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
12695 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
12696 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
12697 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
12700 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
12701 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
12702 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
12703 score with 30 points.
12705 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
12706 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
12707 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
12708 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
12709 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
12711 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
12712 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
12713 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
12714 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
12716 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
12717 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
12718 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
12719 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
12721 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
12722 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
12723 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
12725 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
12726 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
12727 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
12728 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
12731 @node Home Score File
12732 @section Home Score File
12734 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
12735 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
12736 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
12737 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
12739 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
12740 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
12741 could perhaps use the same home score file.
12743 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
12744 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
12749 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
12753 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
12754 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
12758 A list. The elements in this list can be:
12762 @var{(regexp file-name)}. If the @var{regexp} matches the group name,
12763 the @var{file-name} will will be used as the home score file.
12766 A function. If the function returns non-nil, the result will be used as
12767 the home score file.
12770 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
12773 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
12778 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
12781 (setq gnus-home-score-file
12782 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
12785 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
12786 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
12788 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
12790 (setq gnus-home-score-file
12791 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
12794 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
12795 Other functions include
12798 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
12799 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
12800 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
12801 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
12805 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
12806 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
12807 their own home score files:
12810 (setq gnus-home-score-file
12811 ;; All groups that match the regexp "\\.emacs"
12812 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
12813 ;; All the comp groups in one score file
12814 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
12817 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
12818 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
12819 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
12820 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
12821 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
12823 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
12824 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
12825 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
12826 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
12827 precedence over this variable.
12830 @node Followups To Yourself
12831 @section Followups To Yourself
12833 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
12834 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
12835 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
12836 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
12837 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
12838 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
12842 @item gnus-score-followup-article
12843 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
12844 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
12847 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
12848 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
12849 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
12853 @vindex message-sent-hook
12854 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
12855 @code{message-sent-hook}.
12857 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
12858 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
12862 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
12863 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
12866 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
12867 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
12872 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore.no>"
12876 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
12877 is system-dependent.
12881 @section Scoring Tips
12882 @cindex scoring tips
12888 @cindex scoring crossposts
12889 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
12890 the @code{Xref} header.
12892 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
12895 @item Multiple crossposts
12896 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
12897 more than, say, 3 groups:
12899 ("xref" ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+" -1000 nil r))
12902 @item Matching on the body
12903 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
12904 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
12905 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
12906 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
12907 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
12908 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
12909 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
12912 @item Marking as read
12913 You will probably want to mark articles that has a score below a certain
12914 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
12915 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
12919 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
12921 @item Negated character classes
12922 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
12923 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
12924 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
12928 @node Reverse Scoring
12929 @section Reverse Scoring
12930 @cindex reverse scoring
12932 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
12933 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
12934 like this in your score file:
12938 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
12943 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
12944 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
12947 @node Global Score Files
12948 @section Global Score Files
12949 @cindex global score files
12951 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
12952 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
12953 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
12955 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
12956 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
12957 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
12959 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
12960 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
12961 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
12962 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
12963 files are applicable to which group.
12965 Say you want to use the score file
12966 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
12967 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory:
12970 (setq gnus-global-score-files
12971 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
12972 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
12975 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
12976 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
12977 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
12978 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
12979 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
12981 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
12982 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
12984 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
12985 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
12986 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
12987 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
12988 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
12989 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
12991 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
12997 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
12999 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
13001 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
13003 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
13004 lowered out of existence.
13006 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
13007 articles completely.
13010 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
13011 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
13012 old articles for a long time.
13015 ... I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
13016 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
13017 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
13018 holding our breath yet?
13022 @section Kill Files
13025 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
13026 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
13027 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
13029 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
13030 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
13031 files into score files.
13033 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
13034 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
13035 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
13036 that isn't a very good idea.
13038 Normal kill files look like this:
13041 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13042 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
13046 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
13047 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
13049 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
13050 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
13053 Two summary functions for editing a GNUS kill file:
13058 @kindex M-k (Summary)
13059 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
13060 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
13063 @kindex M-K (Summary)
13064 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
13065 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
13068 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
13073 @kindex M-k (Group)
13074 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
13075 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
13078 @kindex M-K (Group)
13079 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
13080 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
13083 Kill file variables:
13086 @item gnus-kill-file-name
13087 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
13088 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
13089 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
13090 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
13091 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
13092 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
13094 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
13095 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
13096 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
13097 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
13100 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
13101 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
13102 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
13103 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
13104 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
13105 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
13106 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
13107 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
13108 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
13110 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
13111 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
13112 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
13117 @node Converting Kill Files
13118 @section Converting Kill Files
13120 @cindex converting kill files
13122 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
13123 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
13124 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
13127 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
13128 You can fetch it from
13129 @file{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-other/gnus-kill-to-score}.
13131 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
13132 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
13133 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
13141 GroupLens is a collaborative filtering system that helps you work
13142 together with other people to find the quality news articles out of the
13143 huge volume of news articles generated every day.
13145 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
13146 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
13147 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
13148 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
13149 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
13150 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
13151 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
13152 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
13156 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
13157 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
13158 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
13159 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
13163 @node Using GroupLens
13164 @subsection Using GroupLens
13166 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local Better
13168 @samp{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html} is the only
13169 better bit in town at the moment.
13171 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
13175 @item gnus-use-grouplens
13176 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
13177 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
13178 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
13180 @item grouplens-pseudonym
13181 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
13182 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
13183 with the Better Bit Bureau.
13185 @item grouplens-newsgroups
13186 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
13187 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
13191 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
13192 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
13193 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
13194 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
13195 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
13196 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
13199 @node Rating Articles
13200 @subsection Rating Articles
13202 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
13203 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
13204 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
13205 yourself is, "on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
13208 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
13213 @kindex r (GroupLens)
13214 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
13215 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
13218 @kindex k (GroupLens)
13219 @findex grouplens-score-thread
13220 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
13221 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
13222 threads in rec.humor.
13226 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
13227 the score of the article you're reading.
13232 @kindex n (GroupLens)
13233 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
13234 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
13237 @kindex , (GroupLens)
13238 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
13239 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
13243 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
13244 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
13247 @node Displaying Predictions
13248 @subsection Displaying Predictions
13250 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
13251 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
13252 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
13253 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
13254 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
13256 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
13257 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
13258 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
13259 regular gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
13260 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
13261 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
13262 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
13263 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
13264 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
13265 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
13266 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
13267 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
13268 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
13270 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
13271 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
13272 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
13273 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
13275 The following are valid values for that variable.
13278 @item prediction-spot
13279 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
13282 @item confidence-interval
13283 A numeric confidence interval.
13285 @item prediction-bar
13286 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
13288 @item confidence-bar
13289 Numerical confidence.
13291 @item confidence-spot
13292 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
13294 @item prediction-num
13295 Plain-old numeric value.
13297 @item confidence-plus-minus
13298 Prediction +/- confidence.
13303 @node GroupLens Variables
13304 @subsection GroupLens Variables
13308 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
13309 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
13310 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
13311 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20n%]%)
13314 @item grouplens-bbb-host
13315 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
13318 @item grouplens-bbb-port
13319 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
13321 @item grouplens-score-offset
13322 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
13323 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
13326 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
13327 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
13328 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
13333 @node Advanced Scoring
13334 @section Advanced Scoring
13336 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
13337 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
13338 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
13339 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
13340 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
13342 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
13346 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
13347 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
13348 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
13352 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
13353 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
13355 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
13356 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
13357 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
13358 non-@code{nil} value.
13360 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
13361 operator, and various match operators.
13368 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
13369 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
13370 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
13375 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
13376 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
13377 then this operator will return @code{false}.
13382 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
13383 logical negation of the value of its argument.
13387 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
13388 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
13389 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
13390 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
13391 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
13392 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
13393 the ancestry you want to go.
13395 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
13396 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
13397 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
13398 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
13399 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
13402 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
13403 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
13405 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
13406 when he's talking about Gnus:
13410 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13411 ("subject" "Gnus"))
13417 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
13421 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13428 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
13429 really don't want to read what he's written:
13433 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13434 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
13438 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
13439 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
13440 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
13447 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
13448 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
13449 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
13450 ("body" "white.*socks"))
13454 The possibilities are endless.
13457 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
13458 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
13460 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
13461 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
13462 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
13463 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
13464 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
13465 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
13466 @samp{subject}) first.
13468 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
13469 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
13480 Then that means "score on the from header of the grandparent of the
13481 current article". An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
13487 ("subject" "Gnus")))
13494 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
13495 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
13500 @section Score Decays
13501 @cindex score decays
13504 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
13505 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
13506 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
13507 use them in any sensible way.
13509 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
13510 @findex gnus-decay-score
13511 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
13512 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
13513 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
13514 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
13515 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
13516 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
13517 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
13518 definition of that function:
13521 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
13522 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant' and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
13525 (* (if (< score 0) 1 -1)
13527 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
13529 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
13532 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
13533 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
13534 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
13535 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
13539 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
13542 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
13545 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
13549 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
13550 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
13551 the new score, which should be an integer.
13553 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
13554 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
13561 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
13562 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
13563 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
13564 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
13565 * Windows Configuration:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
13566 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
13567 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
13568 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
13569 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
13570 * Buttons:: Get tendonitis in ten easy steps!
13571 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
13572 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
13573 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
13574 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
13575 * XEmacs Enhancements:: There are more pictures and stuff under XEmacs.
13576 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
13577 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
13578 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
13582 @node Process/Prefix
13583 @section Process/Prefix
13584 @cindex process/prefix convention
13586 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
13587 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
13589 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
13590 command to be performed on.
13594 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
13595 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
13596 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
13597 with the current one.
13599 @vindex transient-mark-mode
13600 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
13601 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
13603 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
13604 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
13607 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
13608 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
13610 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
13613 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
13614 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
13615 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
13616 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
13618 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
13619 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
13620 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
13621 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
13622 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
13623 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
13624 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
13625 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
13629 @section Interactive
13630 @cindex interaction
13634 @item gnus-novice-user
13635 @vindex gnus-novice-user
13636 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
13637 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
13638 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
13639 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
13642 @item gnus-expert-user
13643 @vindex gnus-expert-user
13644 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
13645 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
13646 matter how strange.
13648 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
13649 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
13650 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
13651 is @code{t} by default.
13653 @item gnus-interactive-exit
13654 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
13655 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
13660 @node Symbolic Prefixes
13661 @section Symbolic Prefixes
13662 @cindex symbolic prefixes
13664 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
13665 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
13666 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
13667 rule of 900 to the current article.
13669 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
13670 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
13671 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
13672 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
13673 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
13674 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
13675 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
13677 @kindex M-i (Summary)
13678 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
13679 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
13680 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
13681 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
13682 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a M-C-u} means ``feed the @kbd{M-C-u}
13683 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b M-C-u} means
13684 ``feed the @kbd{M-C-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
13685 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
13687 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
13688 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
13689 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
13691 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
13695 @node Formatting Variables
13696 @section Formatting Variables
13697 @cindex formatting variables
13699 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
13700 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
13701 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
13702 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
13703 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
13706 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
13707 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
13708 lots of percentages everywhere.
13711 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
13712 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
13713 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
13714 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
13715 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
13718 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
13719 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
13720 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
13721 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
13722 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
13723 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
13724 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
13725 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
13727 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
13728 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
13730 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
13731 @findex gnus-update-format
13732 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
13733 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
13734 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
13735 examine the resulting lisp code to be run to generate the line.
13739 @node Formatting Basics
13740 @subsection Formatting Basics
13742 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
13743 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
13744 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
13746 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
13747 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
13748 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
13749 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
13750 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
13753 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
13754 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
13755 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
13756 less than 4 characters wide.
13759 @node Mode Line Formatting
13760 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
13762 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
13763 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
13764 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
13765 with the following two differences:
13770 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
13773 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
13774 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
13775 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
13776 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
13777 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
13778 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
13779 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
13784 @node Advanced Formatting
13785 @subsection Advanced Formatting
13787 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
13788 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
13789 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
13790 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
13792 These are the valid modifiers:
13797 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
13801 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
13806 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
13809 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
13814 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
13817 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
13820 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
13823 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
13827 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
13828 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
13829 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
13830 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
13831 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
13832 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
13833 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
13835 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
13836 last operation, padding.
13838 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
13839 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
13840 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
13841 @xref{Compilation}.
13844 @node User-Defined Specs
13845 @subsection User-Defined Specs
13847 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
13848 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
13849 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
13850 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
13851 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
13852 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
13853 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
13854 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
13855 should protect against that.
13857 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
13858 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
13859 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
13860 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
13864 @node Formatting Fonts
13865 @subsection Formatting Fonts
13867 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
13868 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
13869 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
13870 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
13873 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
13874 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
13875 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
13876 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
13877 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
13878 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
13880 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
13883 ;; Create three face types.
13884 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
13885 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
13887 ;; We want the article count to be in
13888 ;; a bold and green face. So we create
13889 ;; a new face called `my-green-bold'.
13890 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
13892 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
13893 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
13895 ;; Set the new & fancy format.
13896 (setq gnus-group-line-format
13897 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
13900 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
13901 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
13903 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
13904 mode-line variables.
13907 @node Windows Configuration
13908 @section Windows Configuration
13909 @cindex windows configuration
13911 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
13913 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
13914 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
13915 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
13916 @code{t} by default.
13918 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
13919 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
13920 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
13923 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
13924 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
13925 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
13929 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
13930 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
13931 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
13932 possible names is listed below.
13934 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
13935 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
13938 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
13942 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
13943 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
13944 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
13945 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
13946 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
13947 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
13948 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
13949 size spec per split.
13951 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
13952 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
13953 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
13954 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
13955 present) gets focus.
13957 Here's a more complicated example:
13960 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
13961 (summary 0.25 point)
13962 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
13966 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
13967 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
13968 occupy, not a percentage.
13970 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
13971 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
13972 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
13973 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
13974 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
13977 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
13980 (article (horizontal 1.0
13985 (summary 0.25 point)
13990 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
13991 @code{horizontal} thingie?
13993 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
13994 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
13995 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
13996 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
13997 the screen is to be given to this strip.
13999 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
14000 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
14001 lines from the splits.
14003 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
14007 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
14008 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
14009 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
14010 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
14011 buffer = "(" buffer-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
14012 size = number | frame-params
14013 buffer-name = group | article | summary ...
14016 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
14017 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
14018 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
14019 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
14021 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
14022 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
14023 @cindex window height
14024 @cindex window width
14025 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
14026 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
14027 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
14028 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
14029 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
14030 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
14032 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
14033 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
14034 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
14035 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
14037 @findex gnus-configure-frame
14038 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
14039 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
14040 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
14041 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
14042 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
14043 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
14044 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
14045 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
14046 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
14047 configuration list.
14050 (gnus-configure-frame
14054 (article 0.3 point))
14062 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
14063 @code{frame} split:
14066 (gnus-configure-frame
14069 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
14071 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
14072 (user-position . t)
14073 (left . -1) (top . 1))
14078 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
14079 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
14080 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
14081 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
14082 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
14083 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
14084 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
14085 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
14088 Here's a list of all possible keys for
14089 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration}:
14091 @code{group}, @code{summary}, @code{article}, @code{server},
14092 @code{browse}, @code{message}, @code{pick}, @code{info},
14093 @code{summary-faq}, @code{edit-group}, @code{edit-server},
14094 @code{edit-score}, @code{post}, @code{reply}, @code{forward},
14095 @code{reply-yank}, @code{mail-bounce}, @code{draft}, @code{pipe},
14096 @code{bug}, @code{compose-bounce}, and @code{score-trace}.
14098 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
14099 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
14100 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
14104 (message (horizontal 1.0
14105 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
14107 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
14112 @findex gnus-add-configuration
14113 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
14114 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
14115 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
14116 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
14119 (gnus-add-configuration
14120 '(article (vertical 1.0
14122 (summary .25 point)
14126 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
14127 @file{.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
14128 Gnus has been loaded.
14130 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
14131 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
14132 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
14133 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
14134 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
14137 @node Faces and Fonts
14138 @section Faces and Fonts
14143 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
14144 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
14145 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
14150 @section Compilation
14151 @cindex compilation
14152 @cindex byte-compilation
14154 @findex gnus-compile
14156 Remember all those line format specification variables?
14157 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
14158 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
14159 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
14160 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
14161 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
14164 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
14165 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
14166 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
14167 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
14168 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
14169 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
14170 them into the @code{.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
14174 @section Mode Lines
14177 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
14178 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
14179 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
14180 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
14181 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
14182 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
14183 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
14186 @cindex display-time
14188 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
14189 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
14190 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
14191 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
14192 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
14193 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
14194 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
14195 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
14198 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
14200 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
14201 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
14203 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
14204 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
14205 (length display-time-string)))))
14208 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
14209 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
14210 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
14211 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
14212 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
14215 @node Highlighting and Menus
14216 @section Highlighting and Menus
14218 @cindex highlighting
14221 @vindex gnus-visual
14222 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
14223 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
14224 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
14227 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
14228 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
14231 @item group-highlight
14232 Do highlights in the group buffer.
14233 @item summary-highlight
14234 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
14235 @item article-highlight
14236 Do highlights in the article buffer.
14238 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
14240 Create menus in the group buffer.
14242 Create menus in the summary buffers.
14244 Create menus in the article buffer.
14246 Create menus in the browse buffer.
14248 Create menus in the server buffer.
14250 Create menus in the score buffers.
14252 Create menus in all buffers.
14255 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
14256 buffers, you could say something like:
14259 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
14262 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
14265 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
14268 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
14269 in all Gnus buffers.
14271 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
14274 @item gnus-mouse-face
14275 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
14276 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
14277 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
14281 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
14285 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
14286 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
14287 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
14289 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
14290 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
14291 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
14293 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
14294 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
14295 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
14297 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
14298 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
14299 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
14301 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
14302 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
14303 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
14305 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
14306 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
14307 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
14318 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
14319 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
14320 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
14321 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
14322 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
14326 @vindex gnus-carpal
14327 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
14328 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
14329 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
14334 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
14335 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
14336 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
14338 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
14339 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
14340 Face used on buttons.
14342 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
14343 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
14344 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
14346 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
14347 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
14348 Buttons in the group buffer.
14350 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
14351 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
14352 Buttons in the summary buffer.
14354 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
14355 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
14356 Buttons in the server buffer.
14358 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
14359 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
14360 Buttons in the browse buffer.
14363 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
14364 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
14365 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
14373 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
14374 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
14375 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
14376 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
14377 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
14379 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
14380 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
14381 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
14383 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
14384 been idle for thirty minutes:
14387 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
14390 Here's a handler that scans for PGP headers every hour when Emacs is
14394 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
14397 This @var{time} parameter and than @var{idle} parameter work together
14398 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
14399 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
14401 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
14402 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
14403 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
14404 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
14406 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
14407 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
14408 @var{idle} minutes.
14410 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
14411 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
14414 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
14415 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
14416 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
14418 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
14419 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
14420 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
14421 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
14423 @vindex gnus-use-demon
14424 To set the whole thing in motion, though, you have to set
14425 @code{gnus-use-demon} to @code{t}.
14427 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
14428 your @file{.gnus} file:
14430 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
14432 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
14435 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
14436 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
14437 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
14438 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
14439 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
14440 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
14441 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
14442 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
14443 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
14444 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
14445 @file{.gnus} if you want those abilities.
14447 @findex gnus-demon-init
14448 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
14449 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
14450 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
14451 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
14452 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
14454 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
14455 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
14456 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
14465 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
14466 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
14468 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
14469 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
14470 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
14471 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
14474 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
14475 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
14476 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
14477 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
14479 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
14480 this will make spam disappear.
14482 There are some variables to customize, of course:
14485 @item gnus-use-nocem
14486 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
14487 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
14490 @item gnus-nocem-groups
14491 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
14492 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
14493 default is @code{("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
14494 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")}.
14496 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
14497 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
14498 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
14499 people you want to listen to. The default is @code{("Automoose-1"
14500 "rbraver@@ohww.norman.ok.us" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
14501 "jem@@xpat.com" "snowhare@@xmission.com" "red@@redpoll.mrfs.oh.us
14502 (Richard E. Depew)")}; fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
14504 Known despammers that you can put in this list include:
14507 @item clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca;
14508 @cindex Chris Lewis
14509 Chris Lewis---Major Canadian despammer who has probably canceled more
14510 usenet abuse than anybody else.
14513 @cindex CancelMoose[tm]
14514 The CancelMoose[tm] on autopilot. The CancelMoose[tm] is reputed to be
14515 Norwegian, and was the person(s) who invented NoCeM.
14517 @item jem@@xpat.com;
14519 John Milburn---despammer located in Korea who is getting very busy these
14522 @item red@@redpoll.mrfs.oh.us (Richard E. Depew)
14523 Richard E. Depew---lone American despammer. He mostly cancels binary
14524 postings to non-binary groups and removes spews (regurgitated articles).
14527 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
14528 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
14529 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
14530 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
14531 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
14532 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
14533 @var{(issuer conditions ...)} elements in the list. Each condition is
14534 either a string (which is a regexp that matches types you want to use)
14535 or a list on the form @code{(not STRING)}, where @var{string} is a
14536 regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
14538 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
14539 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
14542 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
14545 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
14546 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
14549 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
14552 The specs are applied left-to-right.
14555 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
14556 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
14558 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
14559 says she is. The default is @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
14560 function. If this is too slow and you don't care for verification
14561 (which may be dangerous), you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
14563 If you want signed NoCeM messages to be verified and unsigned messages
14564 not to be verified (but used anyway), you could do something like:
14567 (setq gnus-nocem-verifyer 'my-gnus-mc-verify)
14569 (defun my-gnus-mc-verify ()
14577 This might be dangerous, though.
14579 @item gnus-nocem-directory
14580 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
14581 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is
14582 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
14584 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
14585 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
14586 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
14587 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
14588 might then see old spam.
14592 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
14593 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
14594 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
14595 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
14602 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
14603 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
14604 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
14606 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
14607 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
14608 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
14609 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
14610 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
14611 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
14612 @code{undo} function.
14614 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
14615 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
14616 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
14617 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
14618 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
14619 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
14620 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
14621 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
14622 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
14623 never be totally undoable.
14625 @findex gnus-undo-mode
14626 @vindex gnus-use-undo
14628 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
14629 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
14630 default. The @kbd{M-C-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo} command
14631 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
14636 @section Moderation
14639 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
14640 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
14641 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
14644 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
14648 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
14651 in your @file{.gnus.el} file.
14653 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
14658 You split your incoming mail by matching on
14659 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
14660 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
14663 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
14664 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
14667 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
14668 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
14672 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
14675 (setq gnus-moderated-list
14676 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
14680 @node XEmacs Enhancements
14681 @section XEmacs Enhancements
14684 XEmacs is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has taken
14688 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what your reading.
14689 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
14690 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
14691 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
14704 So... You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
14705 good way to do so. Its also a great way to impress people staring
14706 over your shoulder as you read news.
14709 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
14710 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
14711 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
14712 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
14713 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
14718 @subsubsection Picon Basics
14720 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
14729 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
14730 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
14731 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
14732 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
14733 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
14734 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
14735 @code{GIF} formats.
14738 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
14739 If you have a permanent connection to the Internet you can use Steve
14740 Kinzler's Picons Search engine by setting
14741 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} to the string
14742 @file{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/search.html}.
14744 @vindex gnus-picons-database
14745 Otherwise you need a local copy of his database. For instructions on
14746 obtaining and installing the picons databases, point your Web browser at
14747 @file{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}. Gnus expects
14748 picons to be installed into a location pointed to by
14749 @code{gnus-picons-database}.
14752 @node Picon Requirements
14753 @subsubsection Picon Requirements
14755 To have Gnus display Picons for you, you must be running XEmacs
14756 19.13 or greater since all other versions of Emacs aren't yet able to
14759 Additionally, you must have @code{x} support compiled into XEmacs. To
14760 display color picons which are much nicer than the black & white one,
14761 you also need one of @code{xpm} or @code{gif} compiled into XEmacs.
14763 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
14764 If you want to display faces from @code{X-Face} headers, you should have
14765 the @code{xface} support compiled into XEmacs. Otherwise you must have
14766 the @code{netpbm} utilities installed, or munge the
14767 @code{gnus-picons-convert-x-face} variable to use something else.
14771 @subsubsection Easy Picons
14773 To enable displaying picons, simply put the following line in your
14774 @file{~/.gnus} file and start Gnus.
14777 (setq gnus-use-picons t)
14778 (add-hook 'gnus-article-display-hook 'gnus-article-display-picons t)
14779 (add-hook 'gnus-article-display-hook 'gnus-picons-article-display-x-face)
14782 and make sure @code{gnus-picons-database} points to the directory
14783 containing the Picons databases.
14785 Alternatively if you want to use the web piconsearch engine add this:
14788 (setq gnus-picons-piconsearch-url "http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch")
14793 @subsubsection Hard Picons
14801 Gnus can display picons for you as you enter and leave groups and
14802 articles. It knows how to interact with three sections of the picons
14803 database. Namely, it can display the picons newsgroup pictures,
14804 author's face picture(s), and the authors domain. To enable this
14805 feature, you need to select where to get the picons from, and where to
14810 @item gnus-picons-database
14811 @vindex gnus-picons-database
14812 The location of the picons database. Should point to a directory
14813 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
14814 subdirectories. This is only useful if
14815 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} is @code{nil}. Defaults to
14816 @file{/usr/local/faces/}.
14818 @item gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
14819 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
14820 The URL for the web picons search engine. The only currently known
14821 engine is @file{http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch}. To
14822 workaround network delays, icons will be fetched in the background. If
14823 this is @code{nil} 'the default), then picons are fetched from local
14824 database indicated by @code{gnus-picons-database}.
14826 @item gnus-picons-display-where
14827 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
14828 Where the picon images should be displayed. It is @code{picons} by
14829 default (which by default maps to the buffer @samp{*Picons*}). Other
14830 valid places could be @code{article}, @code{summary}, or
14831 @samp{*scratch*} for all I care. Just make sure that you've made the
14832 buffer visible using the standard Gnus window configuration
14833 routines---@pxref{Windows Configuration}.
14835 @item gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
14836 @vindex gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
14837 Groups that are matched by this regexp won't have their group icons
14842 Note: If you set @code{gnus-use-picons} to @code{t}, it will set up your
14843 window configuration for you to include the @code{picons} buffer.
14845 Now that you've made those decision, you need to add the following
14846 functions to the appropriate hooks so these pictures will get displayed
14849 @vindex gnus-article-display-hook
14850 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
14852 @item gnus-article-display-picons
14853 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
14854 Looks up and displays the picons for the author and the author's domain
14855 in the @code{gnus-picons-display-where} buffer. Should be added to the
14856 @code{gnus-article-display-hook}.
14858 @item gnus-picons-article-display-x-face
14859 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
14860 Decodes and displays the X-Face header if present. This function
14861 should be added to @code{gnus-article-display-hook}.
14865 Note: You must append them to the hook, so make sure to specify 't'
14866 for the append flag of @code{add-hook}:
14869 (add-hook 'gnus-article-display-hook 'gnus-article-display-picons t)
14873 @node Picon Useless Configuration
14874 @subsubsection Picon Useless Configuration
14882 The following variables offer further control over how things are
14883 done, where things are located, and other useless stuff you really
14884 don't need to worry about.
14888 @item gnus-picons-news-directories
14889 @vindex gnus-picons-news-directories
14890 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
14891 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
14893 @item gnus-picons-user-directories
14894 @vindex gnus-picons-user-directories
14895 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for user
14896 faces. @code{("local" "users" "usenix" "misc")} is the default.
14898 @item gnus-picons-domain-directories
14899 @vindex gnus-picons-domain-directories
14900 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
14901 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
14902 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
14904 @item gnus-picons-convert-x-face
14905 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
14906 If you don't have @code{xface} support builtin XEmacs, this is the
14907 command to use to convert the @code{X-Face} header to an X bitmap
14908 (@code{xbm}). Defaults to @code{(format "@{ echo '/* Width=48,
14909 Height=48 */'; uncompface; @} | icontopbm | pbmtoxbm > %s"
14910 gnus-picons-x-face-file-name)}
14912 @item gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
14913 @vindex gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
14914 Names a temporary file to store the @code{X-Face} bitmap in. Defaults
14915 to @code{(format "/tmp/picon-xface.%s.xbm" (user-login-name))}.
14917 @item gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
14918 @vindex gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
14919 If you have set @code{gnus-picons-display-where} to @code{picons}, your
14920 XEmacs frame will become really cluttered. To alleviate this a bit you
14921 can set @code{gnus-picons-has-modeline-p} to @code{nil}; this will
14922 remove the mode line from the Picons buffer. This is only useful if
14923 @code{gnus-picons-display-where} is @code{picons}.
14925 @item gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
14926 @vindex gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
14927 If non-nil, display the article buffer before computing the picons.
14928 Defaults to @code{nil}.
14930 @item gnus-picons-display-as-address
14931 @vindex gnus-picons-display-as-address
14932 If @code{t} display textual email addresses along with pictures.
14933 Defaults to @code{t}.
14935 @item gnus-picons-file-suffixes
14936 @vindex gnus-picons-file-suffixes
14937 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
14938 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not builtin your XEmacs.
14940 @item gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
14941 @vindex gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
14942 Whether to move point to first empty line when displaying picons. This
14943 has only an effect if `gnus-picons-display-where' has value `article'.
14945 @item gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
14946 @vindex gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
14947 Whether to clear the picons cache when exiting gnus. Gnus caches every
14948 picons it finds while it is running. This saves some time in the search
14949 process but eats some memory. If this variable is set to @code{nil},
14950 Gnus will never clear the cache itself; you will have to manually call
14951 @code{gnus-picons-clear-cache} to clear it. Otherwise the cache will be
14952 cleared every time you exit Gnus. Defaults to @code{t}.
14963 @subsection Smileys
14968 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/BigFace.ps,height=20cm}}
14973 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
14974 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
14976 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
14977 @file{.gnus.el} file:
14980 (add-hook 'gnus-article-display-hook 'gnus-smiley-display t)
14983 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{:-=}, @samp{:-(} and
14984 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
14985 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
14986 text and maps that to file names.
14988 @vindex smiley-nosey-regexp-alist
14989 @vindex smiley-deformed-regexp-alist
14990 Smiley supplies two example conversion alists by default:
14991 @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist} (which matches @samp{:)}, @samp{:(}
14992 and so on), and @code{smiley-nosey-regexp-alist} (which matches
14993 @samp{:-)}, @samp{:-(} and so on).
14995 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist} variable,
14996 which defaults to the value of @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist}.
14998 The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched; the second
14999 element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by the picture;
15000 and the third element is the name of the file to be displayed.
15002 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
15003 files, as well as the color to be used and stuff:
15007 @item smiley-data-directory
15008 @vindex smiley-data-directory
15009 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
15011 @item smiley-flesh-color
15012 @vindex smiley-flesh-color
15013 Skin color. The default is @samp{yellow}, which is really racist.
15015 @item smiley-features-color
15016 @vindex smiley-features-color
15017 Color of the features of the face. The default is @samp{black}.
15019 @item smiley-tongue-color
15020 @vindex smiley-tongue-color
15021 Color of the tongue. The default is @samp{red}.
15023 @item smiley-circle-color
15024 @vindex smiley-circle-color
15025 Color of the circle around the face. The default is @samp{black}.
15027 @item smiley-mouse-face
15028 @vindex smiley-mouse-face
15029 Face used for mouse highlighting over the smiley face.
15035 @subsection Toolbar
15045 @item gnus-use-toolbar
15046 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
15047 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
15048 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
15049 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
15051 @item gnus-group-toolbar
15052 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
15053 The toolbar in the group buffer.
15055 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
15056 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
15057 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
15059 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
15060 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
15061 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
15067 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
15070 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
15071 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
15072 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
15073 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
15074 unusual directory structure.
15076 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
15077 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
15078 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
15079 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
15081 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
15082 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
15083 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
15084 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
15085 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
15086 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
15088 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
15089 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
15090 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
15104 @node Fuzzy Matching
15105 @section Fuzzy Matching
15106 @cindex fuzzy matching
15108 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
15109 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
15111 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
15112 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
15113 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
15115 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
15116 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
15117 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
15118 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
15119 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
15122 @node Thwarting Email Spam
15123 @section Thwarting Email Spam
15127 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
15129 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
15130 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
15131 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
15132 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
15133 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
15134 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
15135 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
15136 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
15139 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
15140 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
15141 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
15142 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
15143 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
15144 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
15148 The way to deal with this is having Gnus split out all spam into a
15149 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
15151 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
15152 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
15153 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
15154 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
15155 sysadm whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
15156 part of the mail address.)
15159 (setq message-default-news-headers
15160 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
15163 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15164 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
15169 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
15170 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
15171 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
15177 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
15178 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
15179 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
15180 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
15182 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @code{smtp} server
15183 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
15184 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
15185 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
15186 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
15187 your fancy split rule in this way:
15192 (to "larsi" "misc")
15196 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
15197 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
15198 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
15199 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
15200 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
15202 If you are also a lazy net citizen, you will probably prefer complaining
15203 automatically with the @file{gnus-junk.el} package, available FOR FREE
15204 at @file{<URL:http://stud2.tuwien.ac.at/~e9426626/gnus-junk.html>}.
15205 Since most e-mail spam is sent automatically, this may reconcile the
15206 cosmic balance somewhat.
15208 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
15209 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
15210 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
15211 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
15214 @node Various Various
15215 @section Various Various
15221 @item gnus-home-directory
15222 All Gnus path variables will be initialized from this variable, which
15223 defaults to @file{~/}.
15225 @item gnus-directory
15226 @vindex gnus-directory
15227 Most Gnus storage path variables will be initialized from this variable,
15228 which defaults to the @samp{SAVEDIR} environment variable, or
15229 @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
15231 Note that gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{.gnus.el} file is read.
15232 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
15233 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
15234 @file{.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
15236 @item gnus-default-directory
15237 @vindex gnus-default-directory
15238 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
15239 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
15240 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
15241 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
15242 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
15243 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
15246 @vindex gnus-verbose
15247 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
15248 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
15249 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
15250 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
15251 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
15253 @item gnus-verbose-backends
15254 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
15255 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
15256 to the Gnus backends instead of Gnus proper.
15258 @item nnheader-max-head-length
15259 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
15260 When the backends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
15261 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
15262 the absolute max length the backends will try to read before giving up
15263 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
15264 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
15265 @code{t}, the backends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
15266 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
15267 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
15269 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
15270 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
15271 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
15272 read when doing the operation described above.
15274 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
15275 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
15277 @cindex invalid characters in file names
15278 @cindex characters in file names
15279 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
15280 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
15281 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
15284 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
15288 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
15289 Windows (phooey) systems.
15291 @item gnus-hidden-properties
15292 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
15293 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
15294 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
15295 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
15297 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
15298 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
15299 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
15300 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
15301 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
15303 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
15304 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
15305 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
15314 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
15315 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
15317 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
15319 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
15325 Not because of victories @*
15328 but for the common sunshine,@*
15330 the largess of the spring.
15334 but for the day's work done@*
15335 as well as I was able;@*
15336 not for a seat upon the dais@*
15337 but at the common table.@*
15342 @chapter Appendices
15345 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
15346 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
15347 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
15348 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
15349 * A Programmers Guide to Gnus:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
15350 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
15351 * Frequently Asked Questions:: A question-and-answer session.
15359 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
15360 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
15362 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage, you
15363 can point your (feh!) web browser to
15364 @file{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/}. This is also the primary
15365 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is known
15366 as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
15368 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
15369 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
15370 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
15371 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
15372 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
15373 appropriate name, don't you think?)
15375 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
15376 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
15377 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
15378 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
15380 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
15381 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
15382 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
15384 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
15385 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
15387 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
15388 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
15390 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37
15391 releases. If was released as ``Gnus 5.6.29' on March 8th 1998.
15393 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
15394 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'' --
15395 don't panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away.
15396 Slowly. Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're
15397 out of its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up
15401 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
15402 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
15403 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
15404 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
15405 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
15406 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
15407 * Newest Features:: Features so new that they haven't been written yet.
15414 What's the point of Gnus?
15416 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
15417 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
15418 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
15419 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
15420 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
15421 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
15422 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
15423 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
15424 keep track of millions of people who post?
15426 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
15427 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
15428 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
15429 to separate the newsreader from the backends, Gnus now offers a simple
15430 interface for anybody who wants to write new backends for fetching mail
15431 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
15432 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
15433 every one of you to explore and invent.
15435 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
15436 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
15439 @node Compatibility
15440 @subsection Compatibility
15442 @cindex compatibility
15443 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
15444 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
15445 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
15450 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
15454 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
15457 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
15460 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
15461 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
15462 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
15463 important variables have their values copied into their global
15464 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
15465 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
15467 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
15468 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
15469 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
15470 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
15471 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
15475 @cindex highlighting
15476 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
15477 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
15478 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
15479 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
15480 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
15481 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
15484 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
15485 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
15486 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
15487 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
15489 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
15490 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
15491 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
15492 to stop doing it the old way.
15494 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
15496 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
15498 @cindex reporting bugs
15500 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
15501 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
15502 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
15504 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
15505 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
15506 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
15507 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
15512 @subsection Conformity
15514 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
15515 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
15522 There are no known breaches of this standard.
15526 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
15528 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
15529 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
15530 We do have some breaches to this one.
15535 Gnus does no MIME handling, and this standard-to-be seems to think that
15536 MIME is the bees' knees, so we have major breakage here.
15539 This is considered to be a ``vanity header'', while I consider it to be
15540 consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted articles
15541 coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use either of
15542 those for posting articles. I would not have known that if it wasn't
15543 for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
15548 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
15549 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
15554 @subsection Emacsen
15560 Gnus should work on :
15565 Emacs 19.32 and up.
15568 XEmacs 19.14 and up.
15571 Mule versions based on Emacs 19.32 and up.
15575 Gnus will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than that. Not
15576 reliably, at least.
15578 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
15579 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
15580 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
15585 @subsection Contributors
15586 @cindex contributors
15588 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
15589 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
15590 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
15591 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
15592 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
15593 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
15594 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
15595 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
15596 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
15597 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
15599 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for... oops,
15605 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
15608 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
15609 well as numerous other things).
15612 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
15615 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
15618 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
15619 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
15622 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
15625 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
15626 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
15629 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
15632 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
15635 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
15638 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
15641 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
15642 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
15645 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
15648 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
15651 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
15654 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
15658 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
15661 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
15664 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
15667 Fran
\e$BmP
\e(Bis Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
15668 well as autoconf support.
15672 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
15673 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
15675 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
15680 David K
\e$BiH
\e(Bedal,
15684 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
15688 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
15710 Massimo Campostrini,
15718 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
15724 Michael Welsh Duggan,
15727 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
15731 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
15737 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
15739 Michelangelo Grigni,
15742 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
15744 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c ?
15746 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
15751 Fran
\e$BmP
\e(Bis Felix Ingrand,
15752 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
15754 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
15762 Peter Skov Knudsen,
15763 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
15764 Thor Kristoffersen,
15766 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
15783 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
15784 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
15791 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
15795 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
15797 John McClary Prevost,
15802 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
15807 Christian von Roques,
15809 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
15815 Philippe Schnoebelen,
15817 Randal L. Schwartz,
15845 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
15847 Shenghuo Zhu. @c Zhu
15849 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
15850 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
15851 (550kB and counting).
15853 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
15856 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
15857 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
15861 @subsection New Features
15862 @cindex new features
15865 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
15866 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.3/5.3.
15867 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
15868 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6.29.
15871 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
15872 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
15873 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
15877 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
15879 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
15884 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
15885 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
15888 Local spool and several @sc{nntp} servers can be used at once
15889 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
15892 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
15895 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
15896 All the mail backends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
15897 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
15900 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
15901 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
15902 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
15903 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
15906 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
15907 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
15910 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
15911 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
15912 (@pxref{The Active File}).
15915 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
15916 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
15919 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
15920 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
15921 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
15924 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
15925 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
15926 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
15929 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{.gnus}) to avoid cluttering up
15930 the @file{.emacs} file.
15933 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
15934 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
15937 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
15938 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
15941 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
15942 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
15945 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
15946 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
15949 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
15950 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
15953 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
15956 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
15957 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
15960 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
15961 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
15964 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
15965 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
15968 Gnus can fetch FAQs and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
15971 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
15972 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
15975 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
15979 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
15983 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
15984 configuration (@pxref{Windows Configuration}).
15987 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
15993 @node September Gnus
15994 @subsubsection September Gnus
15998 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/september.ps,height=20cm}}
16002 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
16007 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
16008 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
16012 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
16013 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
16017 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
16021 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
16022 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
16025 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
16029 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
16032 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
16035 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
16038 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
16042 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
16043 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
16046 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
16050 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
16054 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
16058 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
16062 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
16065 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
16066 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
16069 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
16073 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
16074 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
16077 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
16080 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
16081 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
16082 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
16085 Gnus has a new backend (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
16089 The Gnus cache is much faster.
16092 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
16096 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
16097 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
16100 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
16101 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
16104 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
16105 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
16108 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
16109 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
16110 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
16113 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
16114 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
16117 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
16120 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
16123 (add-hook 'gnus-article-display-hook
16124 'gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head)
16128 All mail backends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
16131 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
16134 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
16135 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
16138 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Windows
16142 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
16145 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=tmp/fseptember.ps,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/fseptember.ps,height=5cm}}
16150 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
16153 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
16157 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
16160 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
16164 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
16167 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
16170 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
16171 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
16174 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
16175 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
16179 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
16180 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
16183 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
16187 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
16188 buffer to allow easier treatment.
16191 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
16194 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
16198 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
16202 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
16203 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
16206 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
16210 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
16211 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
16214 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
16215 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
16218 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
16222 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
16225 (add-hook 'gnus-article-display-hook
16226 'gnus-article-hide-boring-headers t)
16230 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
16233 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
16239 @subsubsection Red Gnus
16241 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
16245 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/red.ps,height=20cm}}
16252 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
16255 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
16256 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
16259 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
16260 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
16264 Article washing status can be displayed in the
16265 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
16268 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
16271 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
16272 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
16275 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
16279 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
16280 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
16284 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
16285 Server Internals}).
16288 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
16292 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
16295 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
16296 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
16299 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
16300 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
16301 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
16304 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
16305 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
16308 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
16309 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
16312 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{M-C-_}
16316 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
16317 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
16320 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
16321 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
16324 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
16328 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
16331 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
16335 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
16336 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
16339 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
16340 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
16343 A new command for reading collections of documents
16344 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{M-C-d}
16345 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
16348 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
16352 A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post even when the NNTP
16353 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
16356 A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
16357 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
16358 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
16361 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
16362 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
16366 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
16370 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
16374 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=tmp/fred.ps,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/fred.ps,width=3cm}}
16379 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
16383 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
16387 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
16388 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
16391 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
16394 (add-hook 'gnus-article-display-hook 'gnus-article-emphasize)
16401 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
16403 New features in Gnus 5.6.29:
16408 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
16409 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See
16410 @pxref{Gnus Unplugged} for the full story.
16413 The @code{nndraft} backend has returned, but works differently than
16414 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
16415 group, which is created automatically.
16418 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
16422 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
16425 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
16426 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
16429 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
16433 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
16436 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
16437 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
16440 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
16443 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
16444 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
16447 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
16448 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
16451 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
16452 control over simplification.
16455 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
16458 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
16462 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
16465 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16468 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
16469 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
16470 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
16473 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
16474 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
16477 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
16481 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
16482 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
16485 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
16486 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @sc{nntp} servers.
16489 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
16493 A history of where mails have been split is available.
16496 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
16499 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
16500 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
16503 A new function for citing in Message has been
16504 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
16507 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
16510 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
16514 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
16515 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
16518 The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
16519 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
16522 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} backend.
16525 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
16530 @node Newest Features
16531 @subsection Newest Features
16534 Also known as the @dfn{todo list}. Sure to be implemented before the
16537 Be afraid. Be very afraid.
16539 (That a feature appears in this list doesn't necessarily mean that I've
16540 decided to actually implement it. It just means that I think it sounds
16543 (Yes, this is the actual, up-to-the-second todo list.)
16548 Native @sc{mime} support is something that should be done.
16551 Really do unbinhexing.
16554 I would like the zombie-page to contain an URL to the source of the
16555 latest version of gnus or some explanation on where to find it.
16558 A way to continue editing the latest Message composition.
16561 http://www.sonicnet.com/feature/ari3/
16564 facep is not declared.
16567 Include a section in the manual on why the number of articles
16568 isn't the same in the group buffer and on the SPC prompt.
16571 Interacting with rmail fcc isn't easy.
16576 <URL:http://www.falch.no/people/pepper/DSSSL-Lite/archives/>
16577 <URL:http://www.eit.com/software/hypermail/hypermail.html>
16578 <URL:http://homer.ncm.com/>
16579 <URL:http://www.yahoo.com/Computers_and_Internet/Internet/World_Wide_Web/HTML_Converters/>
16580 http://www.uwsg.indiana.edu/hypermail/linux/kernel/9610/index.html
16581 <URL:http://union.ncsa.uiuc.edu/HyperNews/get/www/html/converters.html>
16582 http://www.miranova.com/gnus-list/
16587 @samp{^-- } is made into - in LaTeX.
16590 gnus-kill is much slower than it was in GNUS 4.1.3.
16593 when expunging articles on low score, the sparse nodes keep hanging on?
16595 starting the first time seems to hang Gnus on some systems. Does
16596 NEWGROUPS answer too fast?
16598 nndir doesn't read gzipped files.
16600 FAQ doesn't have an up node?
16602 when moving mail from a procmail spool to the crash-box,
16603 the crash-box is only appropriate to one specific group.
16605 `t' `t' makes X-Faces disappear.
16607 nnmh-be-safe means that crossposted articles will
16608 be marked as unread.
16610 Orphan score entries don't show on "V t" score trace
16612 when clearing out data, the cache data should also be reset.
16614 rewrite gnus-summary-limit-children to be non-recursive
16615 to avoid exceeding lisp nesting on huge groups.
16617 expunged articles are counted when computing scores.
16619 implement gnus-batch-brew-soup
16621 ticked articles aren't easy to read in pick mode -- `n' and
16622 stuff just skips past them. Read articles are the same.
16624 topics that contain just groups with ticked
16625 articles aren't displayed.
16627 nndoc should always allocate unique Message-IDs.
16629 implement gnus-score-thread
16631 If there are mail groups the first time you use Gnus, Gnus'll
16632 make the mail groups killed.
16634 no "no news is good news" when using topics.
16636 when doing crosspost marking, the cache has to be consulted
16637 and articles have to be removed.
16639 nnweb should fetch complete articles when they are split into several
16642 scoring on head immediate doesn't work.
16644 finding short score file names takes forever.
16646 canceling articles in foreign groups.
16648 nntp-open-rlogin no longer works.
16650 C-u C-x C-s (Summary) switches to the group buffer.
16652 move nnmail-split-history out to the backends.
16654 nnweb doesn't work properly.
16656 using a virtual server name as `gnus-select-method' doesn't work?
16658 when killing/yanking a group from one topic to another in a slave, the
16659 master will yank it first to one topic and then add it to another.
16663 warn user about `=' redirection of a group in the active file?
16665 really unbinhex binhex files.
16667 take over the XEmacs menubar and offer a toggle between the XEmacs
16668 bar and the Gnus bar.
16671 push active file and NOV file parsing down into C code.
16672 `(canonize-message-id id)'
16673 `(mail-parent-message-id references n)'
16674 `(parse-news-nov-line &optional dependency-hashtb)'
16675 `(parse-news-nov-region beg end &optional dependency-hashtb fullp)'
16676 `(parse-news-active-region beg end hashtb)'
16681 nnml .overview directory with splits.
16685 postponed commands.
16687 the selected article show have its Subject displayed in its summary line.
16689 when entering groups, get the real number of unread articles from
16692 sort after gathering threads -- make false roots have the
16693 headers of the oldest orphan with a 0 article number?
16695 nndoc groups should inherit the score files of their parents? Also
16696 inherit copy prompts and save files.
16698 command to start up Gnus (if not running) and enter a mail mode buffer.
16700 allow editing the group description from the group buffer
16701 for backends that support that.
16703 gnus-hide,show-all-topics
16705 groups and sub-topics should be allowed to mingle inside each topic,
16706 and not just list all subtopics at the end.
16708 a command to remove all read articles that are not needed to connect
16709 threads -- `gnus-summary-limit-to-sparse-unread'?
16711 a variable to turn off limiting/cutting of threads in the tree buffer.
16713 a variable to limit how many files are uudecoded.
16715 add zombie groups to a special "New Groups" topic.
16717 server mode command: close/open all connections
16719 put a file date in gnus-score-alist and check whether the file
16720 has been changed before using it.
16722 on exit from a digest group, go to the next article in the parent group.
16724 hide (sub)threads with low score.
16726 when expiring, remove all marks from expired articles.
16728 gnus-summary-limit-to-body
16730 a regexp alist that says what level groups are to be subscribed
16731 on. Eg. -- `(("nnml:" . 1))'.
16733 easier interface to nnkiboze to create ephemeral groups that
16734 contain groups that match a regexp.
16736 allow newlines in <URL:> urls, but remove them before using
16739 If there is no From line, the mail backends should fudge one from the
16742 fuzzy simplifying should strip all non-alpha-numerical info
16743 from subject lines.
16745 gnus-soup-brew-soup-with-high-scores.
16747 nntp-ping-before-connect
16749 command to check whether NOV is evil. "list overview.fmt".
16751 when entering a group, Gnus should look through the score
16752 files very early for `local' atoms and set those local variables.
16754 message annotations.
16756 topics are always yanked before groups, and that's not good.
16758 (set-extent-property extent 'help-echo "String to display in minibuf")
16759 to display help in the minibuffer on buttons under XEmacs.
16761 allow group line format spec to say how many articles there
16766 support qmail maildir spools
16768 `run-with-idle-timer' in gnus-demon.
16770 stop using invisible text properties and start using overlays instead
16772 C-c C-f C-e to add an Expires header.
16774 go from one group to the next; everything is expunged; go to the
16775 next group instead of going to the group buffer.
16777 gnus-renumber-cache -- to renumber the cache using "low" numbers.
16779 record topic changes in the dribble buffer.
16781 `nnfolder-generate-active-file' should look at the folders it
16782 finds and generate proper active ranges.
16784 nneething-look-in-files-for-article-heads variable to control
16785 whether nneething should sniff all files in the directories.
16787 gnus-fetch-article -- start Gnus, enter group, display article
16789 gnus-dont-move-articles-to-same-group variable when respooling.
16791 when messages are crossposted between several auto-expirable groups,
16792 articles aren't properly marked as expirable.
16794 nneething should allow deletion/moving.
16796 TAB on the last button should go to the first button.
16798 if the car of an element in `mail-split-methods' is a function,
16799 and the function returns non-nil, use that as the name of the group(s) to
16802 command for listing all score files that have been applied.
16804 a command in the article buffer to return to `summary' config.
16806 `gnus-always-post-using-current-server' -- variable to override
16807 `C-c C-c' when posting.
16809 nnmail-group-spool-alist -- says where each group should use
16812 when an article is crossposted to an auto-expirable group, the article
16813 should be marker as expirable.
16815 article mode command/menu for "send region as URL to browser".
16817 on errors, jump to info nodes that explain the error. For instance,
16818 on invalid From headers, or on error messages from the nntp server.
16820 when gathering threads, make the article that has no "Re: " the parent.
16821 Also consult Date headers.
16823 a token in splits to call shrink-window-if-larger-than-buffer
16825 `1 0 A M' to do matches on the active hashtb.
16827 duplicates -- command to remove Gnus-Warning header, use the read
16828 Message-ID, delete the "original".
16830 when replying to several messages at once, put the "other" message-ids
16831 into a See-Also header.
16833 support setext: URL:http://www.bsdi.com/setext/
16835 support ProleText: <URL:http://proletext.clari.net/prole/proletext.html>
16837 when browsing a foreign server, the groups that are already subscribed
16838 should be listed as such and not as "K".
16840 generate font names dynamically.
16842 score file mode auto-alist.
16844 allow nndoc to change/add/delete things from documents. Implement
16845 methods for each format for adding an article to the document.
16847 `gnus-fetch-old-headers' `all' value to incorporate
16848 absolutely all headers there is.
16850 function like `|', but concatenate all marked articles
16851 and pipe them to the process.
16853 cache the list of killed (or active) groups in a separate file. Update
16854 the file whenever we read the active file or the list
16855 of killed groups in the .eld file reaches a certain length.
16857 function for starting to edit a file to put into
16858 the current mail group.
16860 score-find-trace should display the total score of the article.
16862 "ghettozie" -- score on Xref header and nix it out after using it
16863 to avoid marking as read in other groups it has been crossposted to.
16865 look at procmail splitting. The backends should create
16866 the groups automatically if a spool file exists for that group.
16868 function for backends to register themselves with Gnus.
16870 when replying to several process-marked articles,
16871 have all the From end up in Cc headers? Variable to toggle.
16873 command to delete a crossposted mail article from all
16874 groups it has been mailed to.
16876 `B c' and `B m' should be crosspost aware.
16878 hide-pgp should also hide PGP public key blocks.
16880 Command in the group buffer to respool process-marked groups.
16882 `gnus-summary-find-matching' should accept
16883 pseudo-"headers" like "body", "head" and "all"
16885 When buttifying <URL: > things, all white space (including
16886 newlines) should be ignored.
16888 Process-marking all groups in a topic should process-mark
16889 groups in subtopics as well.
16891 Add non-native groups to the list of killed groups when killing them.
16893 nntp-suggest-kewl-config to probe the nntp server and suggest
16896 add edit and forward secondary marks.
16898 nnml shouldn't visit its .overview files.
16900 allow customizing sorting within gathered threads.
16902 `B q' shouldn't select the current article.
16904 nnmbox should support a newsgroups file for descriptions.
16906 allow fetching mail from several pop servers.
16908 Be able to specify whether the saving commands save the original
16909 or the formatted article.
16911 a command to reparent with the child process-marked (cf. `T ^'.).
16913 I think the possibility to send a password with nntp-open-rlogin
16914 should be a feature in Red Gnus.
16916 The `Z n' command should be possible to execute from a mouse click.
16918 more limiting functions -- date, etc.
16920 be able to limit on a random header; on body; using reverse matches.
16922 a group parameter (`absofucking-total-expiry') that will make Gnus expire
16923 even unread articles.
16925 a command to print the article buffer as postscript.
16927 variable to disable password fetching when opening by nntp-open-telnet.
16929 manual: more example servers -- nntp with rlogin, telnet
16931 checking for bogus groups should clean topic alists as well.
16933 canceling articles in foreign groups.
16935 article number in folded topics isn't properly updated by
16938 Movement in the group buffer to the next unread group should go to the
16939 next closed topic with unread messages if no group can be found.
16941 Extensive info pages generated on the fly with help everywhere --
16942 in the "*Gnus edit*" buffers, for instance.
16944 Topic movement commands -- like thread movement. Up, down, forward, next.
16946 a way to tick/mark as read Gcc'd articles.
16948 a way to say that all groups within a specific topic comes
16949 from a particular server? Hm.
16951 `gnus-article-fill-if-long-lines' -- a function to fill
16952 the article buffer if there are any looong lines there.
16954 `T h' should jump to the parent topic and fold it.
16956 a command to create an ephemeral nndoc group out of a file,
16957 and then splitting it/moving it to some other group/backend.
16959 a group parameter for nnkiboze groups that says that
16960 all kibozed articles should be entered into the cache.
16962 It should also probably be possible to delimit what
16963 `gnus-jog-cache' does -- for instance, work on just some groups, or on
16964 some levels, and entering just articles that have a score higher than
16967 nnfolder should append to the folder instead of re-writing
16968 the entire folder to disk when accepting new messages.
16970 allow all backends to do the proper thing with .gz files.
16972 a backend for reading collections of babyl files nnbabylfolder?
16974 a command for making the native groups into foreign groups.
16976 server mode command for clearing read marks from all groups
16979 when following up multiple articles, include all To, Cc, etc headers
16982 a command for deciding what the total score of the current
16983 thread is. Also a way to highlight based on this.
16985 command to show and edit group scores
16987 a gnus-tree-minimize-horizontal to minimize tree buffers
16990 command to generate nnml overview file for one group.
16992 `C-u C-u a' -- prompt for many crossposted groups.
16994 keep track of which mail groups have received new articles (in this session).
16995 Be able to generate a report and perhaps do some marking in the group
16998 gnus-build-sparse-threads to a number -- build only sparse threads
16999 that are of that length.
17001 have nnmh respect mh's unseen sequence in .mh_profile.
17003 cache the newsgroups descriptions locally.
17005 asynchronous posting under nntp.
17007 be able to control word adaptive scoring from the score files.
17009 a variable to make `C-c C-c' post using the "current" select method.
17011 `limit-exclude-low-scored-articles'.
17013 if `gnus-summary-show-thread' is a number, hide threads that have
17014 a score lower than this number.
17016 split newsgroup subscription variable up into "order" and "method".
17018 buttonize ange-ftp file names.
17020 a command to make a duplicate copy of the current article
17021 so that each copy can be edited separately.
17023 nnweb should allow fetching from the local nntp server.
17025 record the sorting done in the summary buffer so that
17026 it can be repeated when limiting/regenerating the buffer.
17028 nnml-generate-nov-databses should generate for
17031 when the user does commands in the group buffer, check
17032 the modification time of the .newsrc.eld file and use
17033 ask-user-about-supersession-threat. Also warn when trying
17034 to save .newsrc.eld and it has changed.
17036 M-g on a topic will display all groups with 0 articles in
17039 command to remove all topic stuff.
17041 allow exploding incoming digests when reading incoming mail
17042 and splitting the resulting digests.
17044 nnsoup shouldn't set the `message-' variables.
17046 command to nix out all nnoo state information.
17048 nnmail-process-alist that calls functions if group names
17049 matches an alist -- before saving.
17051 use buffer-invisibility-spec everywhere for hiding text.
17053 variable to activate each group before entering them
17054 to get the (new) number of articles. `gnus-activate-before-entering'.
17056 command to fetch a Message-ID from any buffer, even
17057 starting Gnus first if necessary.
17059 when posting and checking whether a group exists or not, just
17060 ask the nntp server instead of relying on the active hashtb.
17062 buttonize the output of `C-c C-a' in an apropos-like way.
17064 `G p' should understand process/prefix, and allow editing
17065 of several groups at once.
17067 command to create an ephemeral nnvirtual group that
17068 matches some regexp(s).
17070 nndoc should understand "Content-Type: message/rfc822" forwarded messages.
17072 it should be possible to score "thread" on the From header.
17074 hitting RET on a "gnus-uu-archive" pseudo article should unpack it.
17076 `B i' should display the article at once in the summary buffer.
17078 remove the "*" mark at once when unticking an article.
17080 `M-s' should highlight the matching text.
17082 when checking for duplicated mails, use Resent-Message-ID if present.
17084 killing and yanking groups in topics should be better. If killing one copy
17085 of a group that exists in multiple topics, only that copy should
17086 be removed. Yanking should insert the copy, and yanking topics
17087 should be possible to be interspersed with the other yankings.
17089 command for enter a group just to read the cached articles. A way to say
17090 "ignore the nntp connection; just read from the cache."
17092 `X u' should decode base64 articles.
17094 a way to hide all "inner" cited text, leaving just the most
17095 recently cited text.
17097 nnvirtual should be asynchronous.
17099 after editing an article, gnus-original-article-buffer should
17102 there should probably be a way to make Gnus not connect to the
17103 server and just read the articles in the server
17105 allow a `set-default' (or something) to change the default
17106 value of nnoo variables.
17108 a command to import group infos from a .newsrc.eld file.
17110 groups from secondary servers have the entire select method
17111 listed in each group info.
17113 a command for just switching from the summary buffer to the group
17116 a way to specify that some incoming mail washing functions
17117 should only be applied to some groups.
17119 Message `C-f C-t' should ask the user whether to heed
17120 mail-copies-to: never.
17122 new group parameter -- `post-to-server' that says to post
17123 using the current server. Also a variable to do the same.
17125 the slave dribble files should autosave to the slave file names.
17127 a group parameter that says what articles to display on group entry, based
17130 a way to visually distinguish slave Gnusae from masters. (Whip instead
17133 Use DJ Bernstein "From " quoting/dequoting, where applicable.
17135 Why is hide-citation-maybe and hide-citation different? Also
17138 group user-defined meta-parameters.
17142 From: John Griffith <griffith@@sfs.nphil.uni-tuebingen.de>
17144 I like the option for trying to retrieve the FAQ for a group and I was
17145 thinking it would be great if for those newsgroups that had archives
17146 you could also try to read the archive for that group. Part of the
17147 problem is that archives are spread all over the net, unlike FAQs.
17148 What would be best I suppose is to find the one closest to your site.
17150 In any case, there is a list of general news group archives at
17151 ftp://ftp.neosoft.com/pub/users/claird/news.lists/newsgroup_archives.html
17158 From: Jason L Tibbitts III <tibbs@@hpc.uh.edu>
17159 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
17161 (gnus-group-add-parameter group
17162 (cons 'gnus-group-date-last-entered (list (current-time-string))))))
17164 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
17165 "Return the date the group was last read."
17166 (cond ((car (gnus-group-get-parameter gnus-tmp-group 'gnus-group-date-last-entered)))
17171 tanken var at n
\e$BiS
\e(B du bruker `gnus-startup-file' som prefix (FOO) til
\92é
\81lete
17172 opp en fil FOO-SERVER, FOO-SERVER.el, FOO-SERVER.eld, kan du la den v
\e$BkS
\e(Be en
17173 liste hvor du bruker hvert element i listen som FOO, istedet. da kunne man
17174 hatt forskjellige serveres startup-filer forskjellige steder.
17178 LMI> Well, nnbabyl could alter the group info to heed labels like
17179 LMI> answered and read, I guess.
17181 It could also keep them updated (the same for the Status: header of
17184 They could be used like this:
17188 `M l <name> RET' add label <name> to current message.
17189 `M u <name> RET' remove label <name> from current message.
17190 `/ l <expr> RET' limit summary buffer according to <expr>.
17192 <expr> would be a boolean expression on the labels, e.g.
17194 `/ l bug & !fixed RET'
17197 would show all the messages which are labeled `bug' but not labeled
17200 One could also imagine the labels being used for highlighting, or
17201 affect the summary line format.
17205 Sender: abraham@@dina.kvl.dk
17207 I'd like a gnus-find-file which work like find file, except that it
17208 would recognize things that looks like messages or folders:
17210 - If it is a directory containing numbered files, create an nndir
17213 - For other directories, create a nneething summary buffer.
17215 - For files matching "\\`From ", create a nndoc/mbox summary.
17217 - For files matching "\\`BABYL OPTIONS:", create a nndoc/baby summary.
17219 - For files matching "\\`[^ \t\n]+:", create an *Article* buffer.
17221 - For other files, just find them normally.
17223 I'd like `nneething' to use this function, so it would work on a
17224 directory potentially containing mboxes or babyl files.
17227 Please send a mail to bwarsaw@@cnri.reston.va.us (Barry A. Warsaw) and
17228 tell him what you are doing.
17231 Currently, I get prompted:
17235 decend into sci.something ?
17239 The problem above is that since there is really only one subsection of
17240 science, shouldn't it prompt you for only descending sci.something? If
17241 there was a sci.somethingelse group or section, then it should prompt
17242 for sci? first the sci.something? then sci.somethingelse?...
17245 Ja, det burde v
\e$BkS
\e(Be en m
\e$BiU
\e(Be
\92é
\81si slikt. Kanskje en ny variabel?
17246 `gnus-use-few-score-files'? S
\92é
\81kunne score-regler legges til den
17247 "mest" lokale score-fila. F. eks. ville no-gruppene betjenes av
17248 "no.all.SCORE", osv.
17251 What i want is for Gnus to treat any sequence or combination of the following
17252 as a single spoiler warning and hide it all, replacing it with a "Next Page"
17258 more than n blank lines
17260 more than m identical lines
17261 (which should be replaced with button to show them)
17263 any whitespace surrounding any of the above
17267 Well, we could allow a new value to `gnus-thread-ignore-subject' --
17268 `spaces', or something. (We could even default to that.) And then
17269 subjects that differ in white space only could be considered the
17270 "same" subject for threading purposes.
17273 Modes to preprocess the contents (e.g. jka-compr) use the second form
17274 "(REGEXP FUNCTION NON-NIL)" while ordinary modes (e.g. tex) use the first
17275 form "(REGEXP . FUNCTION)", so you could use it to distinguish between
17276 those two types of modes. (auto-modes-alist, insert-file-contents-literally.)
17279 Under XEmacs -- do funny article marks:
17282 soup - bowl of soup
17283 score below - dim light bulb
17284 score over - bright light bulb
17287 Yes. I think the algorithm is as follows:
17292 show-list-of-articles-in-group
17293 if (key-pressed == SPACE)
17294 if (no-more-articles-in-group-to-select)
17295 if (articles-selected)
17296 start-reading-selected-articles;
17297 junk-unread-articles;
17302 else if (key-pressed = '.')
17303 if (consolidated-menus) # same as hide-thread in Gnus
17304 select-thread-under-cursor;
17306 select-article-under-cursor;
17310 if (key-pressed == SPACE)
17311 if (more-pages-in-article)
17313 else if (more-selected-articles-to-read)
17320 My precise need here would have been to limit files to Incoming*.
17321 One could think of some `nneething-only-files' variable, but I guess
17322 it would have been unacceptable if one was using many unrelated such
17325 A more useful approach would be to, in response to the `G D' prompt, be
17326 allowed to say something like: `~/.mail/Incoming*', somewhat limiting
17327 the top-level directory only (in case directories would be matched by
17328 the wildcard expression).
17331 It would be nice if it also handled
17333 <URL:news://sunsite.auc.dk/>
17335 which should correspond to `B nntp RET sunsite.auc.dk' in *Group*.
17340 Take a look at w3-menu.el in the Emacs-W3 distribution - this works out
17341 really well. Each menu is 'named' by a symbol that would be on a
17342 gnus-*-menus (where * would be whatever, but at least group, summary, and
17343 article versions) variable.
17345 So for gnus-summary-menus, I would set to '(sort mark dispose ...)
17347 A value of '1' would just put _all_ the menus in a single 'GNUS' menu in
17348 the main menubar. This approach works really well for Emacs-W3 and VM.
17352 nndoc should take care to create unique Message-IDs for all its
17355 gnus-score-followup-article only works when you have a summary buffer
17356 active. Make it work when posting from the group buffer as well.
17357 (message-sent-hook).
17359 rewrite gnus-demon to use run-with-idle-timers.
17362 * Enhancements to Gnus:
17366 * gnus-servers (gnus-start-server-buffer?)--enters Gnus and goes
17367 straight to the server buffer, without opening any connections to
17370 * gnus-server-read-server-newsrc--produces a buffer very similar to
17371 the group buffer, but with only groups from that server listed;
17372 quitting this buffer returns to the server buffer.
17375 add a command to check the integrity of an nnfolder folder --
17376 go through the article numbers and see that there are no duplicates,
17380 `unsmileyfy-buffer' to undo smileification.
17383 a command to give all relevant info on an article, including all
17387 when doing `-request-accept-article', the backends should do
17388 the nnmail duplicate checking.
17391 allow `message-signature-file' to be a function to return the
17392 value of the signature file.
17395 In addition, I would love it if I could configure message-tab so that it
17396 could call `bbdb-complete-name' in other headers. So, some sort of
17399 (setq message-tab-alist
17400 '((message-header-regexp message-expand-group)
17401 ("^\\(To\\|[cC]c\\|[bB]cc\\)" bbdb-complete-name)))
17403 then you could run the relevant function to complete the information in
17407 cache the newsgroups file locally to avoid reloading it all the time.
17410 a command to import a buffer into a group.
17413 nnweb should allow fetching by Message-ID from servers.
17416 point in the article buffer doesn't always go to the
17417 beginning of the buffer when selecting new articles.
17420 a command to process mark all unread articles.
17423 `gnus-gather-threads-by-references-and-subject' -- first
17424 do gathering by references, and then go through the dummy roots and
17425 do more gathering by subject.
17428 gnus-uu-mark-in-numerical-order -- process mark articles in
17429 article numerical order.
17432 (gnus-thread-total-score
17433 (gnus-id-to-thread (mail-header-id (gnus-summary-article-header))))
17437 sorting by score is wrong when using sparse threads.
17440 a command to fetch an arbitrary article -- without having to be
17441 in the summary buffer.
17444 a new nncvs backend. Each group would show an article, using
17445 version branches as threading, checkin date as the date, etc.
17448 http://www.dejanews.com/forms/dnsetfilter_exp.html ?
17449 This filter allows one to construct advance queries on the Dejanews
17450 database such as specifying start and end dates, subject, author,
17451 and/or newsgroup name.
17454 new Date header scoring type -- older, newer
17457 use the summary toolbar in the article buffer.
17460 a command to fetch all articles that are less than X days old.
17463 in pick mode, `q' should save the list of selected articles in the
17464 group info. The next time the group is selected, these articles
17465 will automatically get the process mark.
17468 Isn't it possible to (also?) allow M-^ to automatically try the
17469 default server if it fails on the current server? (controlled by a
17470 user variable, (nil, t, 'ask)).
17473 make it possible to cancel articles using the select method for the
17477 `gnus-summary-select-article-on-entry' or something. It'll default
17478 to t and will select whatever article decided by `gnus-auto-select-first'.
17481 a new variable to control which selection commands should be unselecting.
17482 `first', `best', `next', `prev', `next-unread', `prev-unread' are
17486 be able to select groups that have no articles in them
17487 to be able to post in them (using the current select method).
17490 be able to post via DejaNews.
17493 `x' should retain any sortings that have been performed.
17496 allow the user to specify the precedence of the secondary marks. Also
17497 allow them to be displayed separately.
17500 gnus-summary-save-in-pipe should concatenate the results from
17501 the processes when doing a process marked pipe.
17504 a new match type, like Followup, but which adds Thread matches on all
17505 articles that match a certain From header.
17508 a function that can be read from kill-emacs-query-functions to offer
17509 saving living summary buffers.
17512 a function for selecting a particular group which will contain
17513 the articles listed in a list of article numbers/id's.
17516 a battery of character translation functions to translate common
17517 Mac, MS (etc) characters into ISO 8859-1.
17520 (defun article-fix-m$word ()
17521 "Fix M$Word smartquotes in an article."
17524 (let ((buffer-read-only nil))
17525 (goto-char (point-min))
17526 (while (search-forward "\221" nil t)
17527 (replace-match "`" t t))
17528 (goto-char (point-min))
17529 (while (search-forward "\222" nil t)
17530 (replace-match "'" t t))
17531 (goto-char (point-min))
17532 (while (search-forward "\223" nil t)
17533 (replace-match "\"" t t))
17534 (goto-char (point-min))
17535 (while (search-forward "\224" nil t)
17536 (replace-match "\"" t t)))))
17541 (add-hook 'gnus-exit-query-functions
17543 (if (and (file-exists-p nnmail-spool-file)
17544 (> (nnheader-file-size nnmail-spool-file) 0))
17545 (yes-or-no-p "New mail has arrived. Quit Gnus anyways? ")
17546 (y-or-n-p "Are you sure you want to quit Gnus? "))))
17550 allow message-default-headers to be a function.
17553 new Date score match types -- < > = (etc) that take floating point
17554 numbers and match on the age of the article.
17557 gnus-cacheable-groups
17561 > > > If so, I've got one gripe: It seems that when I fire up gnus 5.2.25
17562 > > > under xemacs-19.14, it's creating a new frame, but is erasing the
17563 > > > buffer in the frame that it was called from =:-O
17565 > > Hm. How do you start up Gnus? From the toolbar or with
17566 > > `M-x gnus-other-frame'?
17568 > I normally start it up from the toolbar; at
17569 > least that's the way I've caught it doing the
17574 all commands that react to the process mark should push
17575 the current process mark set onto the stack.
17578 gnus-article-hide-pgp
17579 Selv ville jeg nok ha valgt
\92é
\81slette den dersom teksten matcher
17581 "\\(This\s+\\)?[^ ]+ has been automatically signed by"
17583 og det er maks hundre tegn mellom match-end og ----linja. Men -det-
17584 er min type heuristikk og langt fra alles.
17587 `gnus-subscribe-sorted' -- insert new groups where they would have been
17588 sorted to if `gnus-group-sort-function' were run.
17591 gnus-(group,summary)-highlight should respect any `face' text props set
17595 use run-with-idle-timer for gnus-demon instead of the
17596 home-brewed stuff for better reliability.
17599 add a way to select which NoCeM type to apply -- spam, troll, etc.
17602 nndraft-request-group should tally autosave files.
17605 implement nntp-retry-on-break and nntp-command-timeout.
17608 gnus-article-highlight-limit that says when not to highlight (long)
17612 (nnoo-set SERVER VARIABLE VALUE)
17618 interrupitng agent fetching of articles should save articles.
17621 command to open a digest group, and copy all the articles there to the
17625 a variable to disable article body highlights if there's more than
17626 X characters in the body.
17629 handle 480/381 authinfo requests separately.
17632 include the texi/dir file in the distribution.
17635 format spec to "tab" to a position.
17638 Move all prompting to the new `M-n' default style.
17641 command to display all dormant articles.
17644 gnus-auto-select-next makeover -- list of things it should do.
17647 a score match type that adds scores matching on From if From has replied
17648 to something someone else has said.
17651 Read Netscape discussion groups:
17652 snews://secnews.netscape.com/netscape.communicator.unix
17655 One command to edit the original version if an article, and one to edit
17656 the displayed version.
17659 @kbd{T v} -- make all process-marked articles the children of the
17663 Switch from initial text to the new default text mechanism.
17666 How about making it possible to expire local articles? Will it be
17667 possible to make various constraints on when an article can be
17668 expired, e.g. (read), (age > 14 days), or the more interesting (read
17672 New limit command---limit to articles that have a certain string
17673 in the head or body.
17676 Allow breaking lengthy NNTP commands.
17679 gnus-article-highlight-limit, to disable highlighting in big articles.
17682 Editing an article should put the article to be edited
17683 in a special, unique buffer.
17686 A command to send a mail to the admin-address group param.
17689 A Date scoring type that will match if the article
17690 is less than a certain number of days old.
17693 New spec: %~(tab 56) to put point on column 56
17696 Allow Gnus Agent scoring to use normal score files.
17699 Rething the Agent active file thing. `M-g' doesn't update the active
17700 file, for instance.
17703 With dummy roots, `^' and then selecing the first article
17704 in any other dummy thread will make gnus highlight the
17705 dummy root instead of the first article.
17708 Propagate all group properties (marks, article numbers, etc) up to the
17709 topics for displaying.
17712 `n' in the group buffer with topics should go to the next group
17713 with unread articles, even if that group is hidden in a topic.
17716 gnus-posting-styles doesn't work in drafts.
17719 gnus-summary-limit-include-cached is slow when there are
17720 many articles in the cache, since it regenerates big parts of the
17721 summary buffer for each article.
17724 Solve the halting problem.
17733 @section The Manual
17737 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
17738 either @code{texi2dvi}
17740 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
17741 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
17743 to get what you hold in your hands now.
17745 The following conventions have been used:
17750 This is a @samp{string}
17753 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
17756 This is a @file{file}
17759 This is a @code{symbol}
17763 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
17767 (setq flargnoze "yes")
17770 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
17773 (setq flumphel 'yes)
17776 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
17777 ever get them confused.
17781 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
17782 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
17783 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
17784 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
17785 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
17786 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
17787 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
17795 @section Terminology
17797 @cindex terminology
17802 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
17803 News is generally fetched from a nearby @sc{nntp} server, and is
17804 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
17805 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
17806 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
17810 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
17811 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
17812 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
17813 not posting, and replying is not following up.
17817 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
17821 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
17826 Gnus gets fed articles from a number of backends, both news and mail
17827 backends. Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this
17828 is all done by the backends.
17832 Gnus will always use one method (and backend) as the @dfn{native}, or
17833 default, way of getting news.
17837 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
17838 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary backends for getting
17843 Secondary backends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
17844 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
17848 A message that has been posted as news.
17851 @cindex mail message
17852 A message that has been mailed.
17856 A mail message or news article
17860 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
17865 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
17870 A line from the head of an article.
17874 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
17875 collection of @sc{nov} lines.
17879 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the backend for the headers of all
17880 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
17881 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
17882 normal @sc{head} format.
17886 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
17887 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
17888 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
17889 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
17890 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
17891 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
17893 @item killed groups
17894 @cindex killed groups
17895 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
17896 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
17898 @item zombie groups
17899 @cindex zombie groups
17900 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
17903 @cindex active file
17904 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
17905 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
17906 is rather large, as you might surmise.
17909 @cindex bogus groups
17910 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
17911 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
17912 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
17915 @cindex activating groups
17916 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
17917 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
17918 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
17922 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
17924 @item select method
17925 @cindex select method
17926 A structure that specifies the backend, the server and the virtual
17929 @item virtual server
17930 @cindex virtual server
17931 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
17932 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
17933 whole is a virtual server.
17937 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
17938 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
17941 @item ephemeral groups
17942 @cindex ephemeral groups
17943 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
17944 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
17945 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
17948 @cindex solid groups
17949 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
17950 group buffer are solid groups.
17952 @item sparse articles
17953 @cindex sparse articles
17954 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
17955 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
17959 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
17960 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
17964 @cindex thread root
17965 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
17966 articles in the thread.
17970 An article that has responses.
17974 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
17978 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
17979 specified by RFC1153.
17985 @node Customization
17986 @section Customization
17987 @cindex general customization
17989 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
17990 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
17991 for some quite common situations.
17994 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
17995 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
17996 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
17997 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
18001 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
18002 @subsection Slow/Expensive @sc{nntp} Connection
18004 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
18005 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
18006 Gnus has to get from the @sc{nntp} server.
18010 @item gnus-read-active-file
18011 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
18012 entire active file from the server. This file is often v. large. You
18013 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
18014 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
18015 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
18017 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
18018 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
18019 the @sc{nntp} server will not be very fast. Not all @sc{nntp} servers
18020 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
18024 @node Slow Terminal Connection
18025 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
18027 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
18028 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
18029 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
18033 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
18034 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
18035 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
18036 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
18037 horizontal and vertical recentering.
18039 @item gnus-visible-headers
18040 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
18041 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
18042 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
18043 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
18045 @item gnus-article-display-hook
18046 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
18048 (setq gnus-article-display-hook
18049 '(gnus-article-hide-headers gnus-article-hide-signature
18050 gnus-article-hide-citation))
18053 @item gnus-use-full-window
18054 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
18055 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
18056 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
18057 want to read them anyway.
18059 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
18060 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
18063 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
18064 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
18065 lines, which might save some time.
18069 @node Little Disk Space
18070 @subsection Little Disk Space
18073 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
18074 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
18078 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
18079 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
18080 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
18081 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
18084 @item gnus-save-killed-list
18085 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
18086 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
18087 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
18088 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
18094 @subsection Slow Machine
18095 @cindex slow machine
18097 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
18098 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
18100 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
18101 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
18103 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
18104 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
18105 summary buffer faster.
18107 Set @code{gnus-article-display-hook} to @code{nil} to make article
18108 processing a bit faster.
18112 @node Troubleshooting
18113 @section Troubleshooting
18114 @cindex troubleshooting
18116 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
18124 Make sure your computer is switched on.
18127 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
18128 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
18132 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
18133 like @samp{Gnus v5.46; nntp 4.0} you have the right files loaded. If,
18134 on the other hand, you get something like @samp{NNTP 3.x} or @samp{nntp
18135 flee}, you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
18138 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a FAQ and a
18142 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
18143 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
18144 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
18145 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
18146 something like that.
18149 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
18152 @cindex reporting bugs
18154 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
18156 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
18157 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
18158 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
18159 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
18161 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
18162 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
18163 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
18164 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
18167 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
18168 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
18169 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
18170 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
18171 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
18172 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
18174 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
18175 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
18176 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
18179 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
18180 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful.
18182 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
18183 @cindex ding mailing list
18184 You can also ask on the ding mailing list---@samp{ding@@gnus.org}.
18185 Write to @samp{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
18189 @node A Programmers Guide to Gnus
18190 @section A Programmer@'s Guide to Gnus
18192 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
18193 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
18194 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
18195 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
18198 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
18199 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
18200 backends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
18201 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
18202 and general methods of operation.
18205 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
18206 * Backend Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
18207 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
18208 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
18209 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
18210 * Group Info:: The group info format.
18211 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
18212 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
18213 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
18217 @node Gnus Utility Functions
18218 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
18219 @cindex Gnus utility functions
18220 @cindex utility functions
18222 @cindex internal variables
18224 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
18225 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
18226 Below is a list of the most common ones.
18230 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
18231 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
18232 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
18234 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
18235 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
18236 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
18238 @item gnus-group-real-name
18239 @findex gnus-group-real-name
18240 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
18243 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
18244 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
18245 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
18246 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
18248 @item gnus-get-info
18249 @findex gnus-get-info
18250 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
18252 @item gnus-group-unread
18253 @findex gnus-group-unread
18254 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
18258 @findex gnus-active
18259 The active entry for @var{group}.
18261 @item gnus-set-active
18262 @findex gnus-set-active
18263 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
18265 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
18266 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
18267 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
18270 @item gnus-continuum-version
18271 @findex gnus-continuum-version
18272 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
18273 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
18276 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
18277 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
18278 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
18280 @item gnus-news-group-p
18281 @findex gnus-news-group-p
18282 Says whether @var{group} came from a news backend.
18284 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
18285 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
18286 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
18288 @item gnus-server-to-method
18289 @findex gnus-server-to-method
18290 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
18292 @item gnus-server-equal
18293 @findex gnus-server-equal
18294 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
18296 @item gnus-group-native-p
18297 @findex gnus-group-native-p
18298 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
18300 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
18301 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
18302 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
18304 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
18305 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
18306 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
18308 @item group-group-find-parameter
18309 @findex group-group-find-parameter
18310 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
18311 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
18313 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
18314 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
18315 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
18317 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
18318 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
18319 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
18321 @item gnus-check-backend-function
18322 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
18323 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the backend
18324 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
18327 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
18331 @item gnus-read-method
18332 @findex gnus-read-method
18333 Prompts the user for a select method.
18338 @node Backend Interface
18339 @subsection Backend Interface
18341 Gnus doesn't know anything about @sc{nntp}, spools, mail or virtual
18342 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
18343 server is a @dfn{backend} and some @dfn{backend variables}. As examples
18344 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
18345 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
18346 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
18348 When Gnus asks for information from a backend---say @code{nntp}---on
18349 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
18350 function parameters. (If not, the backend should use the ``current''
18351 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
18352 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
18353 been opened, the function should fail.
18355 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
18356 name. Take this example:
18360 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
18361 (nntp-port-number 4324))
18364 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
18365 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
18367 The backends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
18368 The standard backends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
18369 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
18371 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
18372 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
18373 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
18375 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
18376 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
18377 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
18378 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
18379 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
18380 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
18383 Some backends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} backends, and
18384 some might be said not to be. The latter are backends that generally
18385 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
18386 -- they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
18389 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary backend
18392 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
18395 * Required Backend Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
18396 * Optional Backend Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
18397 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
18398 * Writing New Backends:: Extending old backends.
18399 * Hooking New Backends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
18400 * Mail-like Backends:: Some tips on mail backends.
18404 @node Required Backend Functions
18405 @subsubsection Required Backend Functions
18409 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
18411 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
18412 @code{Message-ID}s. Current backends do not fully support either---only
18413 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most backends do not support
18414 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
18416 The result data should either be HEADs or NOV lines, and the result
18417 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
18418 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
18419 of HEADs and NOV lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
18421 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching "extra
18422 headers", in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
18423 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
18424 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
18425 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the backend finds it
18426 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
18427 number, do maximum fetches.
18429 Here's an example HEAD:
18432 221 1056 Article retrieved.
18433 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
18434 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
18435 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
18436 Subject: Re: Something very droll
18437 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
18438 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
18440 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
18441 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
18442 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
18446 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
18447 these in the data buffer.
18449 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
18453 head = error / valid-head
18454 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
18455 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
18456 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
18457 header = <text> eol
18460 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
18461 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
18465 nov-buffer = *nov-line
18466 nov-line = 8*9 [ field <TAB> ] eol
18467 field = <text except TAB>
18470 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
18474 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
18476 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
18477 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
18479 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The backend
18480 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
18481 server. In fact, it should do so.
18483 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
18484 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
18487 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
18489 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
18490 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
18493 There should be no data returned.
18496 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
18498 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the backend
18499 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that backend
18500 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
18501 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
18503 There should be no data returned.
18506 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
18508 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
18509 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
18510 non-@code{nil} vlue. This function should under no circumstances
18511 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
18513 There should be no data returned.
18516 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
18518 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
18520 There should be no data returned.
18523 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
18525 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
18526 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
18527 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
18528 it would be nice if that were possible.
18530 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
18531 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
18532 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
18533 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
18534 into its article buffer.
18536 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
18537 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
18538 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
18539 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
18540 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
18541 on successful article retrieval.
18544 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
18546 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
18547 making @var{group} the current group.
18549 If @var{FAST}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
18552 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
18555 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
18558 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
18559 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
18560 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
18561 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
18562 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
18563 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
18564 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
18565 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader.
18568 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
18569 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
18570 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
18574 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
18576 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
18577 a no-op on most backends.
18579 There should be no data returned.
18582 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
18584 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
18587 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
18590 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
18591 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
18594 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
18595 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag.
18598 active-file = *active-line
18599 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
18601 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
18604 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
18605 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
18606 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
18609 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
18611 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
18612 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
18613 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
18614 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
18615 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
18616 clear if the posting could not be completed.
18618 There should be no result data from this function.
18623 @node Optional Backend Functions
18624 @subsubsection Optional Backend Functions
18628 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
18630 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
18631 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
18632 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
18634 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
18635 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
18636 former is in the same format as the data from
18637 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
18638 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
18641 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
18645 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
18647 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the backend for
18648 alterations. This comes in handy if the backend really carries all the
18649 information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
18650 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
18651 should return the (altered) group info.
18653 There should be no result data from this function.
18656 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
18658 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
18659 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
18660 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
18661 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
18662 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
18663 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
18664 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
18665 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
18667 There should be no result data from this function.
18670 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
18672 If the user tries to set a mark that the backend doesn't like, this
18673 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
18674 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
18675 @var{mark}. If the backend doesn't care, it must return the original
18676 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
18678 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
18679 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
18680 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
18683 There should be no result data from this function.
18686 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
18688 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
18689 request that the backend check for incoming articles, in one way or
18690 another. A mail backend will typically read the spool file or query the
18691 POP server when this function is invoked. The @var{group} doesn't have
18692 to be heeded---if the backend decides that it is too much work just
18693 scanning for a single group, it may do a total scan of all groups. It
18694 would be nice, however, to keep things local if that's practical.
18696 There should be no result data from this function.
18699 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
18701 The result data from this function should be a description of
18705 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
18707 description = <text>
18710 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
18712 The result data from this function should be the description of all
18713 groups available on the server.
18716 description-buffer = *description-line
18720 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
18722 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
18723 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date
18724 format. The data should be in the active buffer format.
18727 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
18729 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
18731 There should be no return data.
18734 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
18736 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
18737 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
18738 numbers.) It is left up to the backend to decide how old articles
18739 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
18740 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
18743 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
18746 There should be no result data returned.
18749 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM
18752 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
18753 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
18755 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
18756 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
18757 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
18758 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
18759 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
18760 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
18762 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
18763 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
18766 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
18767 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
18769 There should be no data returned.
18772 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
18774 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
18775 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
18776 this function in short order.
18778 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
18779 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
18781 There should be no data returned.
18784 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
18786 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
18787 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
18789 There should be no data returned.
18792 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
18794 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
18795 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
18796 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
18798 There should be no data returned.
18801 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
18803 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
18804 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
18806 There should be no data returned.
18811 @node Error Messaging
18812 @subsubsection Error Messaging
18814 @findex nnheader-report
18815 @findex nnheader-get-report
18816 The backends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
18817 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
18818 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the backend
18819 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
18820 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
18821 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
18824 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
18826 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
18829 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
18830 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
18831 recently reported message for the backend in question. This function
18832 takes one argument---the server symbol.
18834 Internally, these functions access @var{backend}@code{-status-string},
18835 so the @code{nnchoke} backend will have its error message stored in
18836 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
18839 @node Writing New Backends
18840 @subsubsection Writing New Backends
18842 Many backends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
18843 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
18844 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
18845 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
18846 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
18849 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
18850 backends when writing new backends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
18851 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
18853 All the backends declare their public variables and functions by using a
18854 package called @code{nnoo}.
18856 To inherit functions from other backends (and allow other backends to
18857 inherit functions from the current backend), you should use the
18863 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
18864 parameters. For instance:
18867 (nnoo-declare nndir
18871 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
18872 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
18875 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
18876 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
18877 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
18879 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
18880 variables in the parent backends to map the variable to when executing
18881 a function in those backends.
18884 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
18885 "Where nndir will look for groups."
18886 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
18889 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
18890 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
18891 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
18893 @item nnoo-define-basics
18894 This macro defines some common functions that almost all backends should
18898 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
18902 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
18903 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
18904 function as being public so that other backends can inherit it.
18906 @item nnoo-map-functions
18907 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current backend to
18908 functions from the parent backends.
18911 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
18912 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
18913 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
18916 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
18917 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
18918 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
18919 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
18922 This macro allows importing functions from backends. It should be the
18923 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
18924 haven't already been defined.
18930 nnmh-request-newgroups)
18934 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
18935 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
18936 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
18941 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} backend.
18944 ;;; nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus
18945 ;; Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
18949 (require 'nnheader)
18953 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
18955 (nnoo-declare nndir
18958 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
18959 "Where nndir will look for groups."
18960 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
18962 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
18963 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
18966 (defvoo nndir-current-group "" nil nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
18967 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
18968 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
18970 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
18971 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
18973 ;;; Interface functions.
18975 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
18977 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
18978 (setq nndir-directory
18979 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
18981 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
18982 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
18983 (push `(nndir-current-group
18984 ,(file-name-nondirectory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
18986 (push `(nndir-top-directory
18987 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
18989 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
18991 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
18992 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
18993 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
18994 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
18995 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
18999 nnmh-status-message
19001 nnmh-request-newgroups))
19007 @node Hooking New Backends Into Gnus
19008 @subsubsection Hooking New Backends Into Gnus
19010 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
19011 Having Gnus start using your new backend is rather easy---you just
19012 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
19013 enter the backend into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
19015 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the backend name and
19016 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
19021 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
19024 The abilities can be:
19028 This is a mailish backend---followups should (probably) go via mail.
19030 This is a newsish backend---followups should (probably) go via news.
19032 This backend supports both mail and news.
19034 This is neither a post nor mail backend---it's something completely
19037 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
19038 articles and groups.
19040 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
19041 true for almost all backends.
19042 @item prompt-address
19043 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
19044 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for backends like
19045 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
19049 @node Mail-like Backends
19050 @subsubsection Mail-like Backends
19052 One of the things that separate the mail backends from the rest of the
19053 backends is the heavy dependence by the mail backends on common
19054 functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the definition of
19055 @code{nnml-request-scan}:
19058 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
19059 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
19060 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
19063 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
19064 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
19067 This function takes four parameters.
19071 This should be a symbol to designate which backend is responsible for
19074 @item exit-function
19075 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
19077 @item temp-directory
19078 Where the temporary files should be stored.
19081 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
19082 performed for one group only.
19085 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{backend}@code{-save-mail} to
19086 save each article. @var{backend}@code{-active-number} will be called to
19087 find the article number assigned to this article.
19089 The function also uses the following variables:
19090 @var{backend}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
19091 this backend); and @var{backend}@code{-group-alist} and
19092 @var{backend}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
19093 @var{backend}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
19097 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
19098 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
19102 @node Score File Syntax
19103 @subsection Score File Syntax
19105 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
19106 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
19107 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
19109 Here's a typical score file:
19113 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
19120 BNF definition of a score file:
19123 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
19124 element = rule / atom
19125 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
19126 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
19127 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
19128 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
19130 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
19131 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
19132 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
19133 date-header = "date"
19134 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
19135 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
19136 score = "nil" / <integer>
19137 date = "nil" / <natural number>
19138 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
19139 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
19140 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
19141 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
19142 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
19143 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
19144 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
19145 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
19146 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
19147 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
19148 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
19149 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
19150 exclude-files / read-only / touched
19151 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
19152 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
19153 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
19154 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
19155 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
19156 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
19157 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
19158 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
19159 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
19160 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
19161 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
19162 eval = "eval" space <form>
19163 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
19166 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
19169 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
19170 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
19171 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
19172 one looong line, then that's ok.
19174 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
19175 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
19179 @subsection Headers
19181 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
19182 corresponds to the @sc{nov} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
19183 almost suspect that the author looked at the @sc{nov} specification and
19184 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
19186 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
19187 RFC1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
19188 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
19189 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
19190 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
19191 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
19192 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
19194 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
19195 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
19196 @code{xref}. There are macros for accessing and setting these
19197 slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
19198 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
19200 The @code{xref} slot is really a @code{misc} slot. Any extra info will
19207 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
19208 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
19210 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
19211 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
19212 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
19213 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
19215 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
19219 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
19222 is transformed into
19225 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
19228 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
19229 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
19232 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
19235 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
19236 is slightly tricky:
19239 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
19245 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
19248 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
19254 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
19261 and is equal to the previous range.
19263 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
19264 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
19265 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
19269 range = simple-range / normal-range
19270 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
19271 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
19272 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
19273 number *[ " " contents ]
19276 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
19277 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
19278 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
19279 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
19280 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
19285 @subsection Group Info
19287 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
19288 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
19289 describes the group.
19291 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
19292 second is a more complex one:
19295 ("no.group" 5 (1 . 54324))
19297 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
19298 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
19300 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
19303 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
19304 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
19305 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
19306 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
19307 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
19308 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
19309 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
19310 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
19311 this section is about.
19313 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
19314 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
19315 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
19317 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
19320 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
19321 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
19322 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
19323 group = quote <string> quote
19324 ralevel = rank / level
19325 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
19326 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
19327 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
19329 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
19330 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
19331 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
19332 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
19335 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
19336 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
19339 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
19340 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
19343 @item gnus-info-group
19344 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
19345 @findex gnus-info-group
19346 @findex gnus-info-set-group
19347 Get/set the group name.
19349 @item gnus-info-rank
19350 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
19351 @findex gnus-info-rank
19352 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
19353 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
19355 @item gnus-info-level
19356 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
19357 @findex gnus-info-level
19358 @findex gnus-info-set-level
19359 Get/set the group level.
19361 @item gnus-info-score
19362 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
19363 @findex gnus-info-score
19364 @findex gnus-info-set-score
19365 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
19367 @item gnus-info-read
19368 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
19369 @findex gnus-info-read
19370 @findex gnus-info-set-read
19371 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
19373 @item gnus-info-marks
19374 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
19375 @findex gnus-info-marks
19376 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
19377 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
19379 @item gnus-info-method
19380 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
19381 @findex gnus-info-method
19382 @findex gnus-info-set-method
19383 Get/set the group select method.
19385 @item gnus-info-params
19386 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
19387 @findex gnus-info-params
19388 @findex gnus-info-set-params
19389 Get/set the group parameters.
19392 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
19393 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
19395 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
19396 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
19397 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
19398 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
19401 @node Extended Interactive
19402 @subsection Extended Interactive
19403 @cindex interactive
19404 @findex gnus-interactive
19406 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
19407 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
19408 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
19411 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
19412 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
19417 The best thing to do would have been to implement
19418 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
19419 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
19420 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
19421 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
19422 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
19423 @code{interactive}.
19425 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
19430 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
19431 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
19435 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
19436 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
19437 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
19440 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
19444 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
19448 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
19454 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
19455 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
19459 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
19460 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
19461 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
19463 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
19464 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
19465 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
19466 Gnus, that's very useful.
19468 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
19469 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
19470 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
19471 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
19472 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
19473 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
19474 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
19475 following function:
19478 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
19482 (,function ,@@args))
19486 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
19487 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
19488 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
19491 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
19492 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
19493 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
19495 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
19496 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
19497 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
19500 @node Various File Formats
19501 @subsection Various File Formats
19504 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
19505 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
19509 @node Active File Format
19510 @subsubsection Active File Format
19512 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
19513 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
19516 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
19519 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
19520 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
19521 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
19522 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
19523 no.general 1000 900 y
19526 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
19529 active = *group-line
19530 group-line = group space high-number space low-number space flag <NEWLINE>
19531 group = <non-white-space string>
19533 high-number = <non-negative integer>
19534 low-number = <positive integer>
19535 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
19538 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
19539 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
19542 @node Newsgroups File Format
19543 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
19545 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
19546 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
19547 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
19550 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
19551 Here's the definition:
19555 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
19556 group = <non-white-space string>
19558 description = <string>
19563 @node Emacs for Heathens
19564 @section Emacs for Heathens
19566 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
19567 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
19568 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{M-C-a}'', ``kill the
19569 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
19570 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
19571 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
19572 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
19576 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
19577 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
19582 @subsection Keystrokes
19586 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
19589 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
19592 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
19593 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
19594 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
19595 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
19596 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
19597 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
19599 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
19600 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
19601 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
19602 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
19603 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
19604 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
19605 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
19607 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
19608 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{M-C-m}
19609 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
19610 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
19611 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
19612 ``Press @kbd{M-C-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
19613 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
19615 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
19616 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
19617 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
19618 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
19619 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
19625 @subsection Emacs Lisp
19627 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
19628 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
19629 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
19630 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
19632 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
19633 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
19634 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
19635 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
19636 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
19637 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
19638 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
19641 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
19642 write the following:
19645 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
19648 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
19649 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
19650 you can go and fill your @code{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
19653 If you have put that thing in your @code{.emacs} file, it will be read
19654 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
19655 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
19656 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
19657 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
19659 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
19660 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
19661 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
19665 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
19669 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
19672 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
19673 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
19676 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
19679 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
19680 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
19683 @include gnus-faq.texi